blob: dd8649309d3ad2f6e71f240d7a5897eac79cc756 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau6c1b6672019-02-26 16:43:49 +01007 2019/02/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100583 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200584 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-options
588 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200589 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - ssl-default-server-options
591 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100592 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100593 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100594 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100595 - 51degrees-data-file
596 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200597 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200598 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100599 - wurfl-data-file
600 - wurfl-information-list
601 - wurfl-information-list-separator
602 - wurfl-engine-mode
603 - wurfl-cache-size
604 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100605
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200607 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200609 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100610 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100611 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100612 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200613 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200614 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200615 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - noepoll
618 - nokqueue
619 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100620 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300621 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000622 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100623 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200624 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200625 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200626 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000627 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000628 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - tune.buffers.limit
630 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200631 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200632 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100633 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200634 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200635 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200636 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100637 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200638 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200639 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100640 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100641 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100642 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100643 - tune.lua.session-timeout
644 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200645 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100646 - tune.maxaccept
647 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200648 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200649 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200650 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100651 - tune.rcvbuf.client
652 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100653 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200654 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100655 - tune.sndbuf.client
656 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100657 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100658 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200659 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100660 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200661 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200662 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100663 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200664 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100665 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200666 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
667 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
668 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100669 - tune.zlib.memlevel
670 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672 * Debugging
673 - debug
674 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675
676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006773.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200678------------------------------------
679
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200680ca-base <dir>
681 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200682 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
683 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200684
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200685chroot <jail dir>
686 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
687 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
688 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
689 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
690 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100691 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100692
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100693cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
694 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
695 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
696 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
697 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
698 set. These sets have the format
699
700 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
701
702 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100703 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100704 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
705 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100706 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
707 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100708 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100709 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100710 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100711 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
713 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
714 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
715 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100716
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100717 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
718 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
719 on the machine's word size.
720
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100721 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100722 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
723 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
724 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
725 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
726 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
727 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100728
729 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
731
732 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
733 # first 4 CPUs
734
735 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
736 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
737 # word size.
738
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100739 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
742 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
743 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
744
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100745 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
746 # and so on.
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
748 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
749 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
750
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100752 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
753 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
754 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
755
756 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
757 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
758 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
759
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
761 # and a thread range.
762 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
763 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
764 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
765
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200766crt-base <dir>
767 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
768 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
769 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
770
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771daemon
772 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
773 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100774 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
775 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200776
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200777deviceatlas-json-file <path>
778 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100779 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200780
781deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100782 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200783 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
784
785deviceatlas-separator <char>
786 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
787 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
788
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100789deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200790 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
791 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
792 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100793
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900794external-check
795 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
796 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
797 See "option external-check".
798
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200799gid <number>
800 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
801 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
802 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100803 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
804 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100806
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100807hard-stop-after <time>
808 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
809
810 Arguments :
811 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
812 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
813 SIGUSR1 signal.
814
815 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
816 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
817 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
818
819 Example:
820 global
821 hard-stop-after 30s
822
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823group <group name>
824 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
825 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100826
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200827log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100828 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100829 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100830 configured with "log global".
831
832 <address> can be one of:
833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100834 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100835 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
836 port).
837
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100838 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
839 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
840 port).
841
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100842 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100843 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
844 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100845 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100846
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100847 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
848 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
849 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
850 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
851 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
852 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
853 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
854 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
855 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
856 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
857 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
858 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
859 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
860 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100861 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
862 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100863
864 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
865 "fd@2", see above.
866
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200867 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
868 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100869
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200870 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
871 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
872 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
873 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
874 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
875 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
876 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
877 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
878 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
879 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100880 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
881 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200882
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200883 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
884 one of the following :
885
886 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
887 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
888
889 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
890 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
891
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100892 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
893 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
894 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
895 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
896 logger consumes.
897
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100898 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
899 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
900 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
901 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
902
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100903 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200904
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100905 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
906 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
907 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
908
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100909 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
910 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
911 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
912 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200913
914 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200915 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
916 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
917 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
918 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
919 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
920 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200921
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200922 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100924log-send-hostname [<string>]
925 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
926 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
927 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
928 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
929 the logs.
930
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000931log-tag <string>
932 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
933 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
934 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100935 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000936
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100937lua-load <file>
938 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
939 used multiple times.
940
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100941master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200942 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
943 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
944 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100945 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200946 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
947 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100948 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
949 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
950 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
951 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
952 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200953
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100954 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200955
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200956nbproc <number>
957 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
958 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
959 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100960 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
961 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100962 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
963 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200964
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200965nbthread <number>
966 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +0100967 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
968 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
969 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
970 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
971 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100972 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
973 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
974 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
975 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
976 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
977 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
978 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200979
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200980pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100981 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200982 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
983 starting the process. See also "daemon".
984
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100985presetenv <name> <value>
986 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
987 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
988 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
989 and "unsetenv".
990
991resetenv [<name> ...]
992 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
993 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
994 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
995 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
996 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
997 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
998 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
999 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1000
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001001stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001002 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1003 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1004 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1005 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1006 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1007 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001008 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001009 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1010 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1011 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1012 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001013
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001014server-state-base <directory>
1015 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001016 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1017 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001018
1019server-state-file <file>
1020 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1021 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1022 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1023 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1024 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1025 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1026 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1027 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001028 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1029 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001030
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001031setenv <name> <value>
1032 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1033 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1034 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1035 and "unsetenv".
1036
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001037ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1038 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1039 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001040 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001041 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001042 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1043 information and recommendations see e.g.
1044 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1045 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1046 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1047 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001048
1049ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1050 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1051 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1052 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1053 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1054 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001055 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1056 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1057 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001058 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001059
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001060ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1061 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1062 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1063 keyword to see available options.
1064
1065 Example:
1066 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001067 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001068
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001069ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1070 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1071 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001072 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001073 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001074 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1075 information and recommendations see e.g.
1076 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1077 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1078 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1079 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1080 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001081
1082ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1083 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1084 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1085 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1086 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1087 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001088 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1089 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1090 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1091 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001092
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001093ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1094 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1095 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1096 keyword to see available options.
1097
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001098ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1099 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1100 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1101 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001102 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001103 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001104 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1105 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1106 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1107 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001108 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1109 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1110 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1111
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001112ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1113 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1114 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1115 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1116
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001117stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1118 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1119 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1120 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001121 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001122 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001123
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001124 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1125 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1126 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001127
1128stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1129 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1130 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001131 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001132
1133stats maxconn <connections>
1134 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1135 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1136
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001137uid <number>
1138 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1139 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1140 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1141 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1142
1143ulimit-n <number>
1144 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1145 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1146 option.
1147
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001148unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1149 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1150
1151 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1152 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1153 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1154 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1155 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1156 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1157 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1158 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1159 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1160 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1161
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001162unsetenv [<name> ...]
1163 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1164 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1165 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1166 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1167 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1168 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1169 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1170
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001171user <user name>
1172 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1173 See also "uid" and "group".
1174
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001175node <name>
1176 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1177
1178 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1179 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1180 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1181 traffic.
1182
1183description <text>
1184 Add a text that describes the instance.
1185
1186 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1187 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1188 "<" and ">" characters.
1189
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100119051degrees-data-file <file path>
1191 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001192 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001193
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001194 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001195 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1196
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000119751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001198 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1199 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1200 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1201
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001202 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001203 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1204
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200120551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001206 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1207 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1208
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001209 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1210 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1211
121251degrees-cache-size <number>
1213 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1214 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1215 By default, this cache is disabled.
1216
1217 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001218 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1219
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001220wurfl-data-file <file path>
1221 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1222 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1223
1224 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1225 with USE_WURFL=1.
1226
1227wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1228 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1229 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1230 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1231
1232 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1233
1234 Valid WURFL properties are:
1235 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1236
1237 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1238 device.
1239
1240 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1241 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1242
1243 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1244 particular web request.
1245
1246 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1247 used Libwurfl API version.
1248
1249 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1250 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1251 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1252
1253 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1254 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1255
1256 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1257 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1258
1259 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1260
1261 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1262
1263 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1264 with USE_WURFL=1.
1265
1266wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1267 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1268 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1269
1270 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1271 with USE_WURFL=1.
1272
1273wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1274 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1275 thus before the chroot.
1276
1277 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1278 with USE_WURFL=1.
1279
1280wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1281 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1282 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001283 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001284 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001285 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001286 mode is enabled by default.
1287
1288 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1289 with USE_WURFL=1.
1290
1291wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1292 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1293 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1294 - "0" : no cache is used.
1295 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1296 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1297 the highest performing option.
1298
1299 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1300 with USE_WURFL=1.
1301
1302wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1303 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1304 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1305
1306 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1307 with USE_WURFL=1.
1308
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013103.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001311-----------------------
1312
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001313busy-polling
1314 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1315 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1316 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1317 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1318 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1319 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1320 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1321 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1322 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1323 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1324 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1325 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1326 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1327 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1328 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1329 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1330 "poll" pollers.
1331
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001332max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1333 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1334 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1335 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1336 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1337 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1338 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1339 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1340 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1341
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001342maxconn <number>
1343 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1344 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1345 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001346 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1347 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1348 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1349 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001350 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1351 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1352 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1353 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1354 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001355
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001356maxconnrate <number>
1357 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1358 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1359 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1360 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1361 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1362 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1363 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1364 fairness.
1365
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001366maxcomprate <number>
1367 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001368 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001369 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1370 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1371 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001372 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001373 default value.
1374
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001375maxcompcpuusage <number>
1376 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1377 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1378 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1379 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1380 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1381 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1382 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1383 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1384
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001385maxpipes <number>
1386 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1387 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1388 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1389 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1390 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1391 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1392
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001393maxsessrate <number>
1394 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1395 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1396 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1397 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1398 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1399 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1400 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1401 fairness.
1402
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001403maxsslconn <number>
1404 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1405 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1406 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1407 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1408 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1409 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1410 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001411 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1412 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1413 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1414 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1415 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1416 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1417 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001418
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001419maxsslrate <number>
1420 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1421 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1422 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1423 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1424 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1425 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1426 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1427 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1428 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1429 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1430
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001431maxzlibmem <number>
1432 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1433 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1434 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001435 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1436 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1437 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1438
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001439noepoll
1440 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1441 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001442 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001443
1444nokqueue
1445 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1446 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1447 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1448
1449nopoll
1450 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1451 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001452 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001453 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001454
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001455nosplice
1456 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001457 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001458 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001459 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001460 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1461 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1462 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1463 "option splice-response".
1464
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001465nogetaddrinfo
1466 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1467 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1468
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001469noreuseport
1470 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1471 command line argument "-dR".
1472
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001473profiling.tasks { on | off }
1474 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. CPU profiling per
1475 task can be very convenient to report where the time is spent and which
1476 requests have what effect on which other request. It is not enabled by
1477 default as it may consume a little bit extra CPU. This requires a system
1478 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1479 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1480 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1481 CLI.
1482
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001483spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001484 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1485 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1486 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1487 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1488 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1489 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001490
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001491ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001492 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001493 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001494 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1495 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1496 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1497 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1498 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001499 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1500 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001501 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1502 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1503 openssl configuration file uses:
1504 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1505
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001506ssl-mode-async
1507 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001508 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001509 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1510 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1511 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1512 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1513 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001514
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001515tune.buffers.limit <number>
1516 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1517 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1518 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1519 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1520 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001521 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001522 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1523 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1524 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1525 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1526 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1527 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1528 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1529 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1530 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1531
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001532tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1533 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1534 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1535 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1536 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1537
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001538tune.bufsize <number>
1539 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1540 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1541 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1542 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1543 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1544 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1545 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001546 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1547 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1548 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001549 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001550 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1551 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1552 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001553
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001554tune.chksize <number>
1555 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1556 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1557 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1558 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1559 checks whenever possible.
1560
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001561tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1562 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1563 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1564 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1565 this value. The default value is 1.
1566
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001567tune.fail-alloc
1568 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1569 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1570 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1571 gracefully.
1572
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001573tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1574 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1575 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1576 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1577 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1578 change it.
1579
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001580tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1581 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001582 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1583 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001584 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1585 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1586 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1587 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1588 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1589
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001590tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1591 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1592 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1593 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1594 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1595 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1596 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1597 recommended not to change this value.
1598
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001599tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1600 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1601 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1602 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1603 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1604 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1605 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1606 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1607
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001608tune.http.cookielen <number>
1609 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1610 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1611 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1612 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1613 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1614 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1615 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1616 to change this value.
1617
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001618tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001619 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1620 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001621 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001622 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001623 configuration directives too.
1624 The default value is 1024.
1625
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001626tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1627 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1628 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1629 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1630 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1631 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1632 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001633 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1634 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1635 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001636
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001637tune.idletimer <timeout>
1638 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1639 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1640 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1641 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1642 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1643 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001644 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001645 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1646 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1647
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001648tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1649 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1650 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1651 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1652 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1653 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1654 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1655 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1656 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1657 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1658
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001659tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1660 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001661 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001662 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1663 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001664 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001665 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1666 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1667
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001668tune.lua.maxmem
1669 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1670 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1671 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1672 memory.
1673
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001674tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1675 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001676 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1677 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001678 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001679
1680tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1681 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1682 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1683 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1684 check servers.
1685
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001686tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1687 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1688 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1689 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001690 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001691
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001692tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001693 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1694 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1695 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1696 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1697 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1698 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1699 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1700 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1701 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1702 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001703
1704tune.maxpollevents <number>
1705 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1706 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1707 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1708 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1709 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1710
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001711tune.maxrewrite <number>
1712 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1713 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1714 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1715 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1716 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1717 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1718 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1719 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1720 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1721 bufsize.
1722
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001723tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1724 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1725 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1726 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1727 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1728 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1729 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1730 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1731 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1732 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1733 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1734 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1735 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1736 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1737 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1738 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1739 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1740 setting this parameter to 0.
1741
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001742tune.pipesize <number>
1743 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1744 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1745 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1746 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1747 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1748 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1749
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001750tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1751tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1752 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1753 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1754 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1755 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001756 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001757 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1758 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1759
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001760tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001761 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001762 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1763 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1764 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1765 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1766
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001767tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1768 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1769 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1770 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1771
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001772tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1773tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1774 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1775 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1776 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1777 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001778 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001779 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1780 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1781 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1782 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1783 notifying haproxy again.
1784
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001785tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001786 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1787 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1788 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001789 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001790 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001791 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001792 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1793 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1794 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001795 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1796 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001797
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001798tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001799 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001800 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1801 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1802 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1803 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1804 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1805
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001806tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1807 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001808 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001809 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1810 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1811 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1812 being used for too long.
1813
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001814tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1815 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1816 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1817 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1818 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1819 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1820 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1821 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1822 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1823 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1824 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001825 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001826 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001827
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001828tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1829 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1830 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1831 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1832 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1833 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1834 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1835 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001836 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1837 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001838
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001839tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1840 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1841 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1842 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1843 1000 entries.
1844
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001845tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1846 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1847 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1848 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1849
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001850tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001851tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001852tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1853tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1854tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001855 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1856 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1857 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1858 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1859 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1860 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1861 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1862 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001863
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001864 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1865 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1866 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1867 all available space is consumed.
1868 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1869 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1870 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001871
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001872tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1873 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001874 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001875 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001876 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001877 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1878
1879tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1880 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1881 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001882 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1883 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018853.3. Debugging
1886--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001887
1888debug
1889 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1890 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1891 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1892 system startup.
1893
1894quiet
1895 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1896 line argument "-q".
1897
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001898
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018993.4. Userlists
1900--------------
1901It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1902http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1903it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1904
1905userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001906 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001907 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1908
1909group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001910 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001911 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1912 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1913
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001914user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1915 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001916 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1917 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001918 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1919 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1920 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1921 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001922
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001923 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1924 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1925 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1926 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1927 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1928 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1929 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1930 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1931 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001932
1933 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001934 userlist L1
1935 group G1 users tiger,scott
1936 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001937
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001938 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1939 user scott insecure-password elgato
1940 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001941
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001942 userlist L2
1943 group G1
1944 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001945
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001946 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1947 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1948 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001949
1950 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001951
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001952
19533.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001954----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001955It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1956several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1957instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1958values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1959automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1960In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1961using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1962tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1963reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1964Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1965that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1966each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001967
1968peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001969 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001970 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1971
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001972bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1973 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
1974 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
1975
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001976disabled
1977 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1978 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1979 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1980
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001981default-bind [param*]
1982 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
1983
1984default-server [param*]
1985 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
1986
1987 Arguments:
1988 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1989 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1990 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1991 details.
1992
1993
1994 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
1995
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001996enable
1997 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1998
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001999peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002000 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2001 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2002 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2003 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2004 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2005 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2006
2007 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2008 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2009
2010 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2011 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2012 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2013 across all peers.
2014
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002015 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2016 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002017
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002018 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2019 "server" keyword explanation below).
2020
2021server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
2022 As previously mentionned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
2023 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2024 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2025 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2026 of this "peers" section).
2027 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2028
2029
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002030 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002031 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002032 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002033 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2034 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2035 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002036
2037 backend mybackend
2038 mode tcp
2039 balance roundrobin
2040 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2041 stick on src
2042
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002043 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2044 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002045
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002046 Example:
2047 peers mypeers
2048 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2049 default-server ssl verify none
2050 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2051 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002052
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090020533.6. Mailers
2054------------
2055It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2056If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2057in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2058
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002059mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002060 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2061 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2062
2063mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2064 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2065
2066 Example:
2067 mailers mymailers
2068 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2069 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2070
2071 backend mybackend
2072 mode tcp
2073 balance roundrobin
2074
2075 email-alert mailers mymailers
2076 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2077 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2078
2079 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2080 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2081
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002082timeout mail <time>
2083 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2084 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2085 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2086 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2087
2088 Example:
2089 mailers mymailers
2090 timeout mail 20s
2091 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020934. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002094----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002095
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002096Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002097 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002098 - frontend <name>
2099 - backend <name>
2100 - listen <name>
2101
2102A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2103its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2104section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002105section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002106
2107A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2108connections.
2109
2110A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2111to forward incoming connections.
2112
2113A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2114parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002116All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2117'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2118case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2119
2120Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2121logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2122proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2123However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2124name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2125
2126Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2127and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002128bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002129protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2130modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2131arbitrary criteria.
2132
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002133In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2134a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002135the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002136
2137 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2138 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2139 between responses and new requests.
2140
2141 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2142 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2143 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002144 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing. It
2145 is supported only on frontends.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002146
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002147 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2148 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2149 client-facing connection remains open.
2150
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002151 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2152 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002153
2154The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2155frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2156following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002157weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002158
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002159 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002160
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002161 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2162 ----+-----+-----+----
2163 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2164 ----+-----+-----+----
2165 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2166 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2167 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2168 ----+-----+-----+----
2169 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002170
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002171
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021734.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2174--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002175
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002176The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2177limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2178they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2179limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002180marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002181option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002182and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2183with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2184specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002185
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002186
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002187 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2188------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2189acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002190appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002191backlog X X X -
2192balance X - X X
2193bind - X X -
2194bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002195block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002196capture cookie - X X -
2197capture request header - X X -
2198capture response header - X X -
2199clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002200compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002201contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2202cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002203declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002204default-server X - X X
2205default_backend X X X -
2206description - X X X
2207disabled X X X X
2208dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002209email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002210email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002211email-alert mailers X X X X
2212email-alert myhostname X X X X
2213email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002214enabled X X X X
2215errorfile X X X X
2216errorloc X X X X
2217errorloc302 X X X X
2218-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2219errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002220force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002221filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002222fullconn X - X X
2223grace X X X X
2224hash-type X - X X
2225http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002226http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002227http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002228http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002229http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002230http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002231http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002232id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002233ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002234load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002235log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002236log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002237log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002238log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002239max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002240maxconn X X X -
2241mode X X X X
2242monitor fail - X X -
2243monitor-net X X X -
2244monitor-uri X X X -
2245option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2246option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2247option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2248option allbackups (*) X - X X
2249option checkcache (*) X - X X
2250option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2251option contstats (*) X X X -
2252option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2253option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002254option forceclose (deprectated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002255-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2256option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002257option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002258option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002259option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002260option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002261option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002262option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002263option http-tunnel (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002264option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002265option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002266option httpchk X - X X
2267option httpclose (*) X X X X
2268option httplog X X X X
2269option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002270option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002271option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002272option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002273option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2274option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2275option logasap (*) X X X -
2276option mysql-check X - X X
2277option nolinger (*) X X X X
2278option originalto X X X X
2279option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002280option pgsql-check X - X X
2281option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002282option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002283option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002284option smtpchk X - X X
2285option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2286option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2287option splice-request (*) X X X X
2288option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002289option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002290option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2291option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2292-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002293option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002294option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2295option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2296option tcpka X X X X
2297option tcplog X X X X
2298option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002299external-check command X - X X
2300external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002301persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2302rate-limit sessions X X X -
2303redirect - X X X
2304redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2305redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2306reqadd - X X X
2307reqallow - X X X
2308reqdel - X X X
2309reqdeny - X X X
2310reqiallow - X X X
2311reqidel - X X X
2312reqideny - X X X
2313reqipass - X X X
2314reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002315reqitarpit - X X X
2316reqpass - X X X
2317reqrep - X X X
2318-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002319reqtarpit - X X X
2320retries X - X X
2321rspadd - X X X
2322rspdel - X X X
2323rspdeny - X X X
2324rspidel - X X X
2325rspideny - X X X
2326rspirep - X X X
2327rsprep - X X X
2328server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002329server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002330server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002331source X - X X
2332srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002333stats admin - X X X
2334stats auth X X X X
2335stats enable X X X X
2336stats hide-version X X X X
2337stats http-request - X X X
2338stats realm X X X X
2339stats refresh X X X X
2340stats scope X X X X
2341stats show-desc X X X X
2342stats show-legends X X X X
2343stats show-node X X X X
2344stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002345-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2346stick match - - X X
2347stick on - - X X
2348stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002349stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002350stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002351tcp-check connect - - X X
2352tcp-check expect - - X X
2353tcp-check send - - X X
2354tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002355tcp-request connection - X X -
2356tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002357tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002358tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002359tcp-response content - - X X
2360tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002361timeout check X - X X
2362timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002363timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002364timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2365timeout connect X - X X
2366timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2367timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2368timeout http-request X X X X
2369timeout queue X - X X
2370timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002371timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002372timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2373timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002374timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002375transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002376unique-id-format X X X -
2377unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002378use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002379use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002380------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2381 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002382
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002383
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023844.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2385---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002386
2387This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2388
2389
2390acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2391 Declare or complete an access list.
2392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2393 no | yes | yes | yes
2394 Example:
2395 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2396 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2397 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2398
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002399 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002400
2401
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002402appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2403 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002404 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2406 no | no | yes | yes
2407 Arguments :
2408 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2409 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2410
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002411 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002412 checked in each cookie value.
2413
2414 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2415 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2416 milliseconds.
2417
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002418 request-learn
2419 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2420 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2421 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2422 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2423 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2424 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2425
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002426 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2427 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2428 data following this prefix.
2429
2430 Example :
2431 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2432
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002433 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2434 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002435
2436 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2437 2 modes are currently supported :
2438 - path-parameters :
2439 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2440 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2441 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2442 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2443 - query-string :
2444 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2445 query string.
2446
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002447 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2448 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2449 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002450
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002451 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2452 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002453
2454
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002455backlog <conns>
2456 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2458 yes | yes | yes | no
2459 Arguments :
2460 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2461 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002462 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002463
2464 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2465 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2466 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2467 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2468 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2469 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2470 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2471 backlog parameter.
2472
2473 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2474 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2475 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2476
2477 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2478
2479
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002480balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002481balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002482 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2484 yes | no | yes | yes
2485 Arguments :
2486 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2487 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2488 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2489 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2490
2491 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2492 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2493 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2494 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002495 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002496 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002497 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2498 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2499 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2500 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2501 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2502 it, so that you don't worry.
2503
2504 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2505 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2506 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2507 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2508 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2509 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2510 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2511 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002512
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002513 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2514 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2515 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2516 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2517 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2518 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2519 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2520 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2521
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002522 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002523 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002524 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2525 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002526 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002527 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2528 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2529 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2530 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2531 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002532 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2533 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2534 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2535 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2536 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2537 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002538
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002539 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2540 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2541 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2542 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2543 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2544 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2545 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2546 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002547 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002548 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002549 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2550 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2551 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002552
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002553 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2554 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2555 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2556 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2557 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2558 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2559 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2560 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2561 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2562 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2563 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2564 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002565
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002566 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002567 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2568 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2569 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2570 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2571 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2572 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2573 URIs start with a leading "/".
2574
2575 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2576 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2577 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2578 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2579
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002580 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002581 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2582
2583 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002584 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2585 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002586 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2587 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2588 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2589 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002590 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002591 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2592 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002593
2594 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2595 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2596 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2597 server will receive the request.
2598
2599 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2600 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2601 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2602 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2603 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002604 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2605 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2606 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002607
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002608 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2609 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2610 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2611 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2612 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002613
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002614 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002615 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2616 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2617 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2618
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002619 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2620 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2621 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2622
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002623 random
2624 random(<draws>)
2625 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002626 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2627 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2628 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2629 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002630 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2631 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2632 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2633 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2634 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2635 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2636 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2637 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2638 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2639 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2640 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2641 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2642 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2643 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2644 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2645 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2646 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2647 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2648 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2649 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002650
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002651 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002652 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002653 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2654 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2655 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2656 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2657 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2658 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002659 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002660 used instead.
2661
2662 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2663 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2664 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2665 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2666
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002667 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2668 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2669 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2670
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002671 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002672
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002673 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002674 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2675 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002676
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002677 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2678 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2679 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002680
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002681 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2682 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2683 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2684 NTLM relies on.
2685
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002686 Examples :
2687 balance roundrobin
2688 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002689 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002690 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2691 balance hdr(host)
2692 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002693
2694 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2695 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2696
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002697 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002698 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2699 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2700 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2701 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2702
2703 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2704 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2705 defaults to 16 kB.
2706
2707 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2708 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2709
2710 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2711 Round Robin.
2712
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002713 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002714 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2715 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2716 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2717
2718 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2719
2720 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002721 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002722 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2723 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2724 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002725
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002726 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002727
2728
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002729bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2730bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002731 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2733 no | yes | yes | no
2734 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002735 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2736 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2737 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2738 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002739 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002740 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2741 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2742 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2743 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2744 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2745 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2746 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002747 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2748 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2749 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2750 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2751 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2752 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2753 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002754 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2755 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2756 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002757 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2758 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2759 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2760 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002761 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2762 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2763 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002764
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002765 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2766 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002767 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2768 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2769 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002770 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2771 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2772 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2773 the range.
2774
2775 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2776 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2777 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2778 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2779 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2780 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2781 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002782 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002783 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002784
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002785 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002786 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002787 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2788 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2789 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2790 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2791 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2792 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2793
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002794 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2795 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2796 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2797 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002798
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002799 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2800 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2801 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2802 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2803 in a frontend.
2804
2805 Example :
2806 listen http_proxy
2807 bind :80,:443
2808 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002809 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002810
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002811 listen http_https_proxy
2812 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002813 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002814
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002815 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2816 bind ipv6@:80
2817 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2818 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2819
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002820 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002821 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002822
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002823 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2824 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2825 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2826 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2827 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2828
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002829 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002830 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002831
2832
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002833bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002834 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2836 yes | yes | yes | yes
2837 Arguments :
2838 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2839 may be used to override a default value.
2840
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002841 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002842 option may be combined with other numbers.
2843
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002844 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002845 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2846 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2847 missing from all processes.
2848
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002849 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002850 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002851 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2852 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2853 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2854 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2855 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002856 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002857
2858 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2859 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2860 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2861 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2862 and 'even' instances.
2863
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002864 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2865 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2866 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2867 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002868
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002869 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2870 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2871
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002872 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2873 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2874 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2875
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002876 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2877 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2878
2879 Example :
2880 listen app_ip1
2881 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002882 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002883
2884 listen app_ip2
2885 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002886 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002887
2888 listen management
2889 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002890 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002891
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002892 listen management
2893 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2894 bind-process 1-4
2895
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002896 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002897
2898
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002899block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002900 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2902 no | yes | yes | yes
2903
2904 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2905 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002906 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002907 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002908 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002909 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2910 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2911 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002912
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002913 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2914 "http-request deny" instead.
2915
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002916 Example:
2917 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2918 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2919 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002920 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2921 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2922 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002923
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002924 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2925 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2926 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002927
2928capture cookie <name> len <length>
2929 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2931 no | yes | yes | no
2932 Arguments :
2933 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2934 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2935 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2936 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002937 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002938
2939 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2940 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2941 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2942 right if it exceeds <length>.
2943
2944 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2945 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2946 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2947 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2948
2949 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2950 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2951 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2952
2953 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2954 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2955 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002956 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2957 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2958 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002959
2960 Example:
2961 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2962
2963 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002964 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002965
2966
2967capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002968 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2970 no | yes | yes | no
2971 Arguments :
2972 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002973 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002974 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2975 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2976 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2977
2978 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2979 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2980 it exceeds <length>.
2981
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002982 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002983 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2984 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002985 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2986 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2987 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2988 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002989 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002990 environments to find where the request came from.
2991
2992 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2993 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2994 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2995 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002996
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002997 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2998 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2999 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3000 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3001 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003002
3003 Example:
3004 capture request header Host len 15
3005 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003006 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003008 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003009 about logging.
3010
3011
3012capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003013 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3015 no | yes | yes | no
3016 Arguments :
3017 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003018 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003019 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3020 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3021 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3022
3023 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3024 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3025 it exceeds <length>.
3026
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003027 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003028 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3029 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3030 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003031 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3032 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3033 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3034 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003035
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003036 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3037 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3038 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3039 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3040 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003041
3042 Example:
3043 capture response header Content-length len 9
3044 capture response header Location len 15
3045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003046 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003047 about logging.
3048
3049
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003050clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003051 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3053 yes | yes | yes | no
3054 Arguments :
3055 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3056 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3057 as explained at the top of this document.
3058
3059 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3060 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3061 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3062 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3063 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3064 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3065 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3066 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003067 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003068 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003069 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003070
3071 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3072 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3073 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3074 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3075 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3076 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3077
3078 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3079 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3080
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003081 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3082 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003083
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003084compression algo <algorithm> ...
3085compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003086compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003087 Enable HTTP compression.
3088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3089 yes | yes | yes | yes
3090 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003091 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3092 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3093 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3094
3095 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003096 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3097 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3098 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003099
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003100 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003101 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003102
3103 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3104 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3105 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3106 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3107 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003108 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003109
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003110 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3111 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3112 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3113 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3114 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3115 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3116 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003117 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003118
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003119 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003120 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003121 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3122 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3123 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3124 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3125 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003126
3127 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3128 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3129 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3130 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3131 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003132 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3133 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3134 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3135 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3136 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003137 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3138 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003139
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003140 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003141 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3142 "Accept-Encoding" header
3143 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003144 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003145 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3146 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3147 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3148 "multipart"
3149 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3150 header
3151 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3152 and later
3153 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3154 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003155 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003156
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003157 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003158
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003159 Examples :
3160 compression algo gzip
3161 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003163
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003164contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003165 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3167 yes | no | yes | yes
3168 Arguments :
3169 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3170 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3171 as explained at the top of this document.
3172
3173 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003174 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003175 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003176 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003177 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3178 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3179 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3180
3181 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3182 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3183 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3184 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3185 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3186 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3187
3188 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3189 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3190 instead.
3191
3192 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3193 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3194
3195
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003196cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003197 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3198 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003199 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003200 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3202 yes | no | yes | yes
3203 Arguments :
3204 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3205 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3206 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3207 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3208 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3209 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003210 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003211 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3212 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3213
3214 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3215 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3216 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3217 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3218 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3219 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003220 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3221 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003222 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003223 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3224 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003225
3226 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003227 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003228
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003229 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003230 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3231 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003232 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003233 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3234 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3235 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3236 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3237 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3238 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3239 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003240
3241 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3242 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3243 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3244 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3245 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3246 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3247 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3248 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3249 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003250 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003251 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3252 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3253 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003254
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003255 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3256 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3257 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003258 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3259 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3260 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3261 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003262 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3263 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3264 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003265
3266 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3267 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3268 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3269 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3270 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3271 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3272 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3273 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3274 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3275
3276 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3277 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3278 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3279 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3280 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3281 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3282 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3283 persistence cookie in the cache.
3284 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3285
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003286 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3287 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3288 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3289 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3290 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003291 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003292 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3293 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3294 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3295 they logout.
3296
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003297 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3298 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3299 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3300 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3301
3302 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3303 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3304 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3305 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3306 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3307 this attribute.
3308
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003309 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003310 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003311 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3312 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3313 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3314 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3315 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3316 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003317
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003318 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3319 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3320 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3321 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3322 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3323 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3324 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3325 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003326 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003327 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3328 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3329 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3330 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3331 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3332 the site.
3333
3334 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3335 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3336 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3337 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3338 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3339 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3340 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3341 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3342 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3343 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3344 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3345 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3346 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003347 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003348 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3349 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3350
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003351 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3352 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3353 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3354 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3355 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3356 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3357
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003358 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3359 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3360 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3361 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003362
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003363 Examples :
3364 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3365 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3366 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003367 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003368
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003369 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003370
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003371
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003372declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3373 Declares a capture slot.
3374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3375 no | yes | yes | no
3376 Arguments:
3377 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3378
3379 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3380 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3381 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3382 for use in the response.
3383
3384 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003385 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003386 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3387
3388
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003389default-server [param*]
3390 Change default options for a server in a backend
3391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3392 yes | no | yes | yes
3393 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003394 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3395 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3396 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3397 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003398
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003399 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003400 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3401
3402 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003403
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003404
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003405default_backend <backend>
3406 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3408 yes | yes | yes | no
3409 Arguments :
3410 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3411
3412 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3413 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3414 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3415 will catch all undetermined requests.
3416
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003417 Example :
3418
3419 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3420 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3421 default_backend dynamic
3422
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003423 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003424
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003425
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003426description <string>
3427 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3429 no | yes | yes | yes
3430 Arguments : string
3431
3432 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3433 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3434 it describes.
3435 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3436
3437
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003438disabled
3439 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3441 yes | yes | yes | yes
3442 Arguments : none
3443
3444 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3445 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3446 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3447 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3448 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3449 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3450 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3451
3452 See also : "enabled"
3453
3454
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003455dispatch <address>:<port>
3456 Set a default server address
3457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3458 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003459 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003460
3461 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3462 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3463 during start-up.
3464
3465 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3466 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3467 possible with normal servers.
3468
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003469 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003470 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3471 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3472 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3473 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3474
3475 See also : "server"
3476
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003477
3478dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3479 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3481 yes | no | yes | yes
3482 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3483
3484 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003485 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003486 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3487 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003488 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003489 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003490
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003491enabled
3492 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3494 yes | yes | yes | yes
3495 Arguments : none
3496
3497 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3498 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3499
3500 See also : "disabled"
3501
3502
3503errorfile <code> <file>
3504 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3506 yes | yes | yes | yes
3507 Arguments :
3508 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003509 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3510 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003511
3512 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003513 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003514 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003515 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3516 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003517
3518 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3519 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3520 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3521
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003522 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3523
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003524 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3525 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3526 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3527 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3528
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003529 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3530 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003531 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003532 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3533 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3534 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3535
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003536 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3537 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3538 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003539 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003540 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3541
3542 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3543
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003544 Example :
3545 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003546 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003547 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3548 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3549
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003550
3551errorloc <code> <url>
3552errorloc302 <code> <url>
3553 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3555 yes | yes | yes | yes
3556 Arguments :
3557 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003558 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3559 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003560
3561 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3562 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3563 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3564 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003565 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003566
3567 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3568 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3569 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3570
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003571 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3572
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003573 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3574 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3575 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3576 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003577 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003578 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3579 request.
3580
3581 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3582
3583
3584errorloc303 <code> <url>
3585 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3587 yes | yes | yes | yes
3588 Arguments :
3589 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003590 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3591 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003592
3593 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3594 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3595 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3596 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003597 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003598
3599 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3600 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3601 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3602
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003603 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3604
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003605 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3606 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3607 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3608 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003609 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003610
3611 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3612
3613
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003614email-alert from <emailaddr>
3615 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003616 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003617 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3618 yes | yes | yes | yes
3619
3620 Arguments :
3621
3622 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3623
3624 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3625 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3626
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003627 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003628 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3629 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003630
3631
3632email-alert level <level>
3633 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3634 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3635 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3636 yes | yes | yes | yes
3637
3638 Arguments :
3639
3640 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3641 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3642 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3643
3644 By default level is alert
3645
3646 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3647 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3648 for the proxy.
3649
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003650 Alerts are sent when :
3651
3652 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3653 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3654 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3655 is notice or lower
3656 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3657 and a health check status update occurs
3658
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003659 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3660 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003661 section 3.6 about mailers.
3662
3663
3664email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3665 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3666 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3667 yes | yes | yes | yes
3668
3669 Arguments :
3670
3671 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3672
3673 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3674 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3675
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003676 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3677 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003678
3679
3680email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3681 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3682 mailers.
3683 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3684 yes | yes | yes | yes
3685
3686 Arguments :
3687
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003688 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003689
3690 By default the systems hostname is used.
3691
3692 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3693 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3694 for the proxy.
3695
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003696 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3697 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003698
3699
3700email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003701 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003702 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3703 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3704 yes | yes | yes | yes
3705
3706 Arguments :
3707
3708 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3709
3710 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3711 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3712
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003713 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003714 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3715
3716
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003717force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3718 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3719 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003720 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003721
3722 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3723 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3724 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3725 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3726 marked down for maintenance operations.
3727
3728 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3729 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3730 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3731 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3732 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3733 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3734 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3735 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3736 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3737
3738 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3739 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3740 is used.
3741
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003742 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003743 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003744
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003745
3746filter <name> [param*]
3747 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3749 no | yes | yes | yes
3750 Arguments :
3751 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3752 referenced in section 9.
3753
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003754 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003755 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003756 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3757 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003758
3759 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3760 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3761
3762 Example:
3763 listen
3764 bind *:80
3765
3766 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3767 filter compression
3768 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3769
3770 compression algo gzip
3771 compression offload
3772
3773 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3774
3775 See also : section 9.
3776
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003777
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003778fullconn <conns>
3779 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3781 yes | no | yes | yes
3782 Arguments :
3783 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3784 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3785
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003786 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003787 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003788 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003789 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3790 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3791 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3792 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3793 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003794 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003795
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003796 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3797 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003798 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3799 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3800 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003801
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003802 Example :
3803 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3804 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3805 # connections.
3806 backend dynamic
3807 fullconn 10000
3808 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3809 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3810
3811 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3812
3813
3814grace <time>
3815 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003817 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003818 Arguments :
3819 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3820 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3821 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3822
3823 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3824 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003825 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003826 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3827
3828 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3829 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3830 simplify it.
3831
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003832
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003833hash-balance-factor <factor>
3834 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3836 yes | no | no | yes
3837 Arguments :
3838 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3839 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3840 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3841
3842 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3843 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3844 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3845 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3846 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3847 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3848 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3849
3850 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3851 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3852 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3853 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3854 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3855
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003856 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3857 consistent hashing mechanism.
3858
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003859 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3860
3861
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003862hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003863 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3865 yes | no | yes | yes
3866 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003867 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3868 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003869
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003870 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3871 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3872 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3873 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3874 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3875 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3876 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3877 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3878 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3879 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003880
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003881 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3882 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3883 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3884 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3885 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3886 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3887 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3888 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3889 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3890 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3891 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3892 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3893 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003894 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3895 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003896
3897 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3898
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003899 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003900 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3901 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3902 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003903 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3904 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3905 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003906
3907 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3908 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003909 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3910 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3911 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3912 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3913
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003914 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3915 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3916 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3917 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3918 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3919 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3920 parameter.
3921
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003922 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3923 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3924 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3925 used on strings.
3926
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003927 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3928
3929 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3930 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3931 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3932 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3933 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3934 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3935 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3936 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3937 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3938 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3939 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3940 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003941
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003942 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3943 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3944 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003945
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003946 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003947
3948
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003949http-check disable-on-404
3950 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003952 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003953 Arguments : none
3954
3955 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3956 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3957 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3958 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3959 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3960 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3961 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3962 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003963 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3964 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3965 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3966
3967 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3968
3969
3970http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003971 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003973 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003974 Arguments :
3975 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3976 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003977 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003978 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3979 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3980 details on the supported keywords.
3981
3982 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3983 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3984 with the usual backslash ('\').
3985
3986 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3987 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3988 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3989 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3990 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3991
3992 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003993 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003994 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3995 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3996 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3997
3998 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003999 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004000 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4001 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4002 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4003 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4004
4005 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004006 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004007 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4008 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4009 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4010 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4011 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004012 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004013 trace).
4014
4015 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004016 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004017 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4018 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4019 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4020 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4021 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004022 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004023
4024 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4025 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4026 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4027 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4028 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4029 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4030 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4031 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4032
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004033 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4034 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4035 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4036
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004037 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4038 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4039
4040 Examples :
4041 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004042 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004043
4044 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004045 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004046
4047 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004048 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004049
4050 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004051 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004052
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004053 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004054
4055
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004056http-check send-state
4057 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4059 yes | no | yes | yes
4060 Arguments : none
4061
4062 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4063 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4064 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4065 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4066 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4067
4068 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4069 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4070 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4071 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4072 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004073 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4074 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4075 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4076
4077 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4078 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4079 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4080
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004081 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4082 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4083 checked in multiple backends.
4084
4085 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4086 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4087
4088 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4089 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4090 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4091 one fails.
4092
4093 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4094 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4095 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4096
4097 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4098 server's queue.
4099
4100 Example of a header received by the application server :
4101 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4102 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4103
4104 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4105
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004106
4107http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004108 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4109
4110 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4111 no | yes | yes | yes
4112
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004113 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4114 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4115 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4116 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4117 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004118
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004119 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4120 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004121
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004122 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004124 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4125 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4126 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4127 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004128
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004129 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4130 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4131 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4132 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004133
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004134 Example:
4135 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4136 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4137 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004138
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004139 http-request allow if nagios
4140 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4141 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4142 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004143
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004144 Example:
4145 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4146 acl add path /addacl
4147 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004148
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004149 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004150
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004151 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4152 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004153
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004154 Example:
4155 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4156 acl setmap path /setmap
4157 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004158
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004159 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004160
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004161 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4162 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004163
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004164 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4165 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004166
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004167http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004168
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004169 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4170 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4171 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4172 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4173 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4174 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4175 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4176 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004177
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004178http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004179
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004180 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4181 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4182 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4183 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4184 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4185 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4186 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4187 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004188
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004189http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004190
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004191 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4192 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004193
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004194
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004195http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004196
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004197 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4198 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4199 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4200 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4201 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004202
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004203 Example:
4204 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4205 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004206
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004207http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004208
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004209 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004210
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004211http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4212 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004213
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004214 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4215 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4216 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4217 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4218 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4219 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4220 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4221 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4222 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004223
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004224 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4225 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4226 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4227 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4228 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4229 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004230
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004231http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004232
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004233 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4234 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4235 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4236 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4237 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4238 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004239
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004240http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004242 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004243
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004244http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004245
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004246 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4247 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4248 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4249 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4250 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4251 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004252
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004253http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004254
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004255 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4256 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4257 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4258 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4259 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004260
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004261http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4262
4263 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4264 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4265 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4266 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004267 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4268 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004269
4270 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4271
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004272http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004273
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004274 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4275 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4276 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4277 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4278 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004279
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004280http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004281
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004282 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4283 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4284 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4285 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004286
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004287http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4288 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004289
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004290 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4291 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4292 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4293 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4294 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4295 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4296 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4297 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004299 Example:
4300 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004301
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004302 # applied to:
4303 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004304
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004305 # outputs:
4306 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004307
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004308 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004309
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004310http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4311 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004313 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4314 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4315 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4316 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004317
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004318 Example:
4319 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004321 # applied to:
4322 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004324 # outputs:
4325 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004327http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4328http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004330 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4331 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4332 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004334http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004335
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004336 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4337 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4338 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004342 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4343 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4344 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4345 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4346 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004347
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004348 Arguments:
4349 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4350 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004351
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004352 Example:
4353 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4354 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004356 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4357 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004358
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004359http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004360
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004361 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4362 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4363 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004365 Arguments:
4366 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4367 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004369 Example:
4370 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4371 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004373 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4374 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4375 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004376
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004377http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004378
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004379 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4380 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4381 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4382 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4383 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004384
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004385 Example:
4386 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4387 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4388 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4389 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4390 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4391 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4392 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4393 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4394 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004396http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004397
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004398 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4399 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4400 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4401 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4402 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004404http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4405 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004406
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004407 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4408 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4409 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4410 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4411 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4412 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4413 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4414 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4415 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004416
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004417http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004418
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004419 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4420 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4421 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4422 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4423 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4424 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4425 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004426
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004427http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004428
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004429 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4430 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4431 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004432
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004433http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004434
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004435 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4436 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4437 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4438 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4439 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4440 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4441 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4442 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004444http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004445
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004446 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4447 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4448 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4449 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4450 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4451 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004452
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004453 Example :
4454 # prepend the host name before the path
4455 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004456
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004457http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004458
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004459 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4460 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4461 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4462 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4463 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004464
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004465http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004466
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004467 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4468 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4469 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4470 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4471 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4472 values have higher priority.
4473 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4474 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4475 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4476 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4477 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004478
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004479http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004480
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004481 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4482 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4483 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4484 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4485 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4486 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4487 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004488
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004489 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004490
4491 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004492 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4493 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004494
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004495http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4496 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4497 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4498 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4499 privacy.
4500
4501 Arguments :
4502 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4503 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004504
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004505 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004506 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4507 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4508
4509 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4510 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4511
4512http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4513
4514 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4515 expression.
4516
4517 Arguments:
4518 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4519 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004520
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004521 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004522 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4523 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4524
4525 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4526 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4527 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4528
4529http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4530
4531 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4532 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4533 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4534 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4535 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4536 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4537 information from the request.
4538
4539 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4540
4541http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4542
4543 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4544 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4545 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4546 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4547 path and the query string.
4548 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4549
4550http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4551
4552 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4553 inline.
4554
4555 Arguments:
4556 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4557 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4558 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4559 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4560 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4561 (request and response)
4562 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4563 processing
4564 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4565 processing
4566 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4567 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4568 and '_'.
4569
4570 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4571 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004572
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004573 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004574 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004575
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004576http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4577 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004579 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4580 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4581 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4582 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4583 agent name must be used.
4584
4585 Arguments:
4586 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4587
4588 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4589 configuration.
4590
4591http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4592
4593 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4594 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4595 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4596 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4597 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4598 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4599 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4600 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4601 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4602 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4603 action.
4604 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4605 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4606 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4607 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4608 you fully understand how it works.
4609
4610http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4611
4612 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4613 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4614 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4615 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4616 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4617 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4618 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4619 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4620 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4621 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4622 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4623 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4624 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4625
4626http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4627http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4628http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4629
4630 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4631 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4632 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4633 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4634 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4635 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4636 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4637 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4638 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4639 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4640 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4641 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4642
4643 Arguments :
4644 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4645 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4646 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4647 select which table entry to update the counters.
4648
4649 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4650 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4651 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4652 that table until the session ends.
4653
4654 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4655 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4656 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4657 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4658 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4659 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4660 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4661 useful information.
4662
4663 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4664 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4665 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4666 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4667 checks that make use of it.
4668
4669http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4670
4671 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004672
4673 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004674 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004675
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004676http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004677
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004678 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4679 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4680 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004681
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004682
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004683http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004684 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4685
4686 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4687 no | yes | yes | yes
4688
4689 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4690 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4691 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4692 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4693 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4694 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4695
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004696 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4697 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004698
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004699 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004700
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004701 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4702 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4703 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4704 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004705
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004706 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4707 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4708 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4709 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004710
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004711 Example:
4712 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004713
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004714 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004715
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004716 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4717 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004718
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004719 Example:
4720 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004721
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004722 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004723
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004724 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4725 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004726
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004727 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4728 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004729
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004730http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004731
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004732 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4733 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4734 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4735 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4736 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4737 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4738 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4739 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004740
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004741http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004742
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004743 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4744 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4745 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4746 example, or to pass some internal information.
4747 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4748 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4749 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004750
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004751http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004752
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004753 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4754 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004755
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004756http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004757
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004758 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004759
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004760http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004761
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004762 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4763 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4764 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4765 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4766 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4767 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4768 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004769
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004770 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4771 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4772 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4773 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4774 keyword.
4775 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4776 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004777
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004778http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004779
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004780 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4781 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4782 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4783 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4784 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4785 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004786
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004787http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004788
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004789 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004790
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004791http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004792
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004793 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4794 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4795 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4796 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4797 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4798 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004799
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004800http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004801
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004802 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4803 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004804
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004805http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004806
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004807 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4808 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4809 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4810 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4811 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4812 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004813
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004814http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4815 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004816
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004817 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4818 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4819 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4820 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4821 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4822 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4823 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4824 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004825
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004826 Example:
4827 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004828
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004829 # applied to:
4830 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004831
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004832 # outputs:
4833 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004834
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004835 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004836
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004837http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4838 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004839
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004840 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4841 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4842 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4843 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004844
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004845 Example:
4846 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004847
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004848 # applied to:
4849 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004850
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004851 # outputs:
4852 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004853
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004854http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4855http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004856
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004857 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4858 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4859 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004860
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004861http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004862
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004863 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4864 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4865 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004866
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004867http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004868
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004869 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4870 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4871 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4872 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4873 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004874
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004875 Arguments:
4876 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004877
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004878 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4879 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004880
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004881http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004882
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004883 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4884 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4885 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004886
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004887http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4888
4889 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4890 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4891 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4892 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4893 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4894
4895http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4896
4897 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4898 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4899 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4900 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4901 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4902 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4903 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4904 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4905 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4906
4907http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4908
4909 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4910 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4911 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4912 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4913 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4914 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4915 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4916
4917http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4918
4919 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4920 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4921 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4922 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4923 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
4924 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4925 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4926 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4927
4928http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4929 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4930
4931 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4932 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4933 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4934 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004935
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004936 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004937 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4938 http-response set-status 431
4939 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4940 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004941
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004942http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004944 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4945 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4946 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4947 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
4948 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
4949 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
4950 based on some information from the request.
4951
4952 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4953
4954http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4955
4956 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4957 inline.
4958
4959 Arguments:
4960 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4961 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4962 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4963 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4964 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4965 (request and response)
4966 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4967 processing
4968 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4969 processing
4970 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4971 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4972 and '_'.
4973
4974 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4975 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004976
4977 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004978 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004980http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004981
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004982 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4983 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4984 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4985 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4986 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4987 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4988 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4989 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4990 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4991 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4992 action.
4993 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4994 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4995 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4996 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4997 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004998
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004999http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5000http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5001http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005002
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005003 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5004 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5005 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5006 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5007 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5008 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5009
5010http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5011
5012 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5013 about <var-name>.
5014
5015 Example:
5016 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5017
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005018
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005019http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5020 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5021
5022 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5023 yes | no | yes | yes
5024
5025 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005026 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5027 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5028 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005029
5030 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5031
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005032 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5033 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5034 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5035 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5036 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5037 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5038 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5039 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5040 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5041 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005042
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005043 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5044 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5045 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5046 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5047 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5048 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5049 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5050 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005051
5052 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5053 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5054 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5055 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5056 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5057 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5058 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5059 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
5060 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
5061 downsides of rare connection failures.
5062
5063 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5064 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5065 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5066 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5067 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5068 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005069 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005070 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5071 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5072 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5073 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5074 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5075
5076 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005077 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5078 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5079 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005080
5081 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005082 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005083
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005084 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5085 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005086
5087 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5088 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5089 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5090
5091 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5092 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5093 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5094
5095 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5096
5097
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005098http-send-name-header [<header>]
5099 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5100
5101 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5102 yes | no | yes | yes
5103
5104 Arguments :
5105
5106 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5107
5108 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005109 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005110 is added with the header string proved.
5111
5112 See also : "server"
5113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005114id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005115 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5117 no | yes | yes | yes
5118 Arguments : none
5119
5120 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5121 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5122 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005123
5124
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005125ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5126 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5127 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005128 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005129
5130 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5131 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5132 and running).
5133
5134 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5135 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5136 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005137 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005138 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5139
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005140 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5141 "unless" condition is met.
5142
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005143 Example:
5144 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5145 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5146 ignore-persist if url_static
5147
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005148 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5149
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005150load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5151 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5152 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5153 yes | no | yes | yes
5154
5155 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5156 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5157 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005158 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005159 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5160 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5161 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5162 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5163
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005164 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005165 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005166 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005167
5168 Arguments:
5169 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5170 named "server-state-file".
5171
5172 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5173 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5174 name is used as a file name.
5175
5176 none don't load any stat for this backend
5177
5178 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005179 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5180 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5181 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005182 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005183 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005184
5185 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5186 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5187
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005188 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005189
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005190 global
5191 stats socket /tmp/socket
5192 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005193
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005194 defaults
5195 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005196
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005197 backend bk
5198 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5199 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005200
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005201
5202 Then one can run :
5203
5204 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5205
5206 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5207
5208 1
5209 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5210 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5211 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5212
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005213 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005214
5215 global
5216 stats socket /tmp/socket
5217 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5218
5219 defaults
5220 load-server-state-from-file local
5221
5222 backend bk
5223 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5224 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5225
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005226
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005227 Then one can run :
5228
5229 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5230
5231 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5232
5233 1
5234 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5235 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5236 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5237
5238 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5239 "show servers state"
5240
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005241
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005242log global
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005243log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005244no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005245 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5247 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005248
5249 Prefix :
5250 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5251 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5252 prefix does not allow arguments.
5253
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005254 Arguments :
5255 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5256 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5257 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5258 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5259 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5260 parameter.
5261
5262 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5263 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5264
5265 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5266 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5267 standard syslog port).
5268
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005269 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5270 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5271 standard syslog port).
5272
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005273 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5274 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5275 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005276 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005277
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005278 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5279 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5280 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5281 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5282 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5283 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5284 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5285 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5286 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5287 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5288 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5289 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5290 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5291 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5292 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5293 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005294 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5295 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005296
5297 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5298 and "fd@2", see above.
5299
5300 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5301 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005302
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005303 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5304 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5305 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5306 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5307 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5308 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5309 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5310 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5311 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5312 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005313 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005314
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005315 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5316 one of the following :
5317
5318 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5319 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5320
5321 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5322 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5323
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005324 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5325 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5326 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5327 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5328 systemd logger consumes.
5329
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005330 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5331 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5332 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5333 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5334
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005335 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5336
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005337 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5338 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5339 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5340
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005341 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5342 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5343 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5344 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005345
5346 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5347 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5348 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005349 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5350 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5351 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5352 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5353 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005354
5355 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5356
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005357 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5358 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5359 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005360
5361 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5362 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5363 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5364 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5365
5366 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5367 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005368
5369 Example :
5370 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005371 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5372 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5373 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005374 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5375 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005376 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005377
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005378
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005379log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005380 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5381 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5382 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005383
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005384 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5385 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5386 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5387 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5388 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005389
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005390 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5391 "option httplog" directives.
5392
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005393log-format-sd <string>
5394 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5395 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5396 yes | yes | yes | no
5397
5398 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5399 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5400 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5401 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5402 which covers the log format string in depth.
5403
5404 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5405 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5406
5407 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5408 log format to "rfc5424".
5409
5410 Example :
5411 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5412
5413
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005414log-tag <string>
5415 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5416 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5417 yes | yes | yes | yes
5418
5419 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5420 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5421 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5422 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5423 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5424 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5425 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5426 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5427 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005428
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005429max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5430 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5431 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5432 yes | no | yes | yes
5433
5434 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5435 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5436 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5437 servers.
5438
5439 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5440 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5441 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5442 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5443 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005444 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005445 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5446 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5447 picking a different server.
5448
5449 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5450 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5451 even if they have to be queued.
5452
5453 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5454 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5455
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005456max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5457 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5458 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5459 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005460
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005461maxconn <conns>
5462 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5464 yes | yes | yes | no
5465 Arguments :
5466 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5467 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5468 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5469 closes.
5470
5471 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5472 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5473 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5474 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005475 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5476 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5477 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5478 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005479
5480 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5481 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5482 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5483
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005484 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5485
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005486 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5487
5488
5489mode { tcp|http|health }
5490 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5492 yes | yes | yes | yes
5493 Arguments :
5494 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5495 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5496 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5497 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5498
5499 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5500 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5501 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5502 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5503 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5504
5505 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005506 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5507 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5508 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5509 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5510 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5511 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5512 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005513
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005514 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5515 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5516 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005517
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005518 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005519 defaults http_instances
5520 mode http
5521
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005522 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005523
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005524
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005525monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005526 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5528 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005529 Arguments :
5530 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5531 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005532 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005533 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5534 backend and its backup.
5535
5536 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5537 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5538 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5539 servers in a list of backends.
5540
5541 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5542 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5543 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5544 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5545 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5546 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5547 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005548 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5549 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005550
5551 Example:
5552 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005553 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005554 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5555 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5556 monitor-uri /site_alive
5557 monitor fail if site_dead
5558
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005559 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005560
5561
5562monitor-net <source>
5563 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5565 yes | yes | yes | no
5566 Arguments :
5567 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5568 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5569 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5570 followed by a mask.
5571
5572 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5573 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005574 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005575 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5576
5577 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5578 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5579 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5580 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005581 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5582 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5583 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005584
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005585 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5586 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5587 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5588 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5589 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5590 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005591
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005592 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5593 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005594
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005595 Example :
5596 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5597 frontend www
5598 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5599
5600 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5601
5602
5603monitor-uri <uri>
5604 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5606 yes | yes | yes | no
5607 Arguments :
5608 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5609 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5610
5611 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5612 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5613 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5614 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5615 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5616 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5617 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5618 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5619
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005620 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5621 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5622 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5623 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5624 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5625 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5626 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5627 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005628
5629 Example :
5630 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5631 frontend www
5632 mode http
5633 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5634
5635 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5636
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005637
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005638option abortonclose
5639no option abortonclose
5640 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5642 yes | no | yes | yes
5643 Arguments : none
5644
5645 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5646 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5647 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5648 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005649 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005650 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5651 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5652 encountered while delivering the response.
5653
5654 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5655 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5656 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5657 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5658 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5659 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005660 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005661 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005662 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005663 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5664 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5665 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5666
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005667 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5668 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005669 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5670 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5671 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5672 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5673 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5674 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005675 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005676
5677 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5678 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5679
5680 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5681
5682
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005683option accept-invalid-http-request
5684no option accept-invalid-http-request
5685 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5687 yes | yes | yes | no
5688 Arguments : none
5689
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005690 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005691 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005692 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005693 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5694 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5695 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5696 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5697 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005698 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5699 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5700 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5701 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005702 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005703 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005704 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5705 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5706 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005707
5708 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5709 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5710 been confirmed.
5711
5712 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5713 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005714 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5715 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005716 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5717
5718 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5719 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5720
5721 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5722 stats socket.
5723
5724
5725option accept-invalid-http-response
5726no option accept-invalid-http-response
5727 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5729 yes | no | yes | yes
5730 Arguments : none
5731
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005732 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005733 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005734 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005735 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5736 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5737 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5738 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5739 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005740 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5741 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5742 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005743
5744 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5745 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5746 been confirmed.
5747
5748 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5749 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5750 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5751 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5752
5753 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5754 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5755
5756 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5757 stats socket.
5758
5759
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005760option allbackups
5761no option allbackups
5762 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5764 yes | no | yes | yes
5765 Arguments : none
5766
5767 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5768 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5769 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5770 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5771 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5772 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5773 order between the backup servers anymore.
5774
5775 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5776 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5777
5778 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5779 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5780
5781
5782option checkcache
5783no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005784 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5786 yes | no | yes | yes
5787 Arguments : none
5788
5789 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5790 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005791 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005792 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5793 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005794 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005795
5796 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005797 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005798 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005799 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5800 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005801 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005802 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005803 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5804 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005805 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005806 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5807 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005808 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005809 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5810 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5811 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5812 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5813 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5814 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5815 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5816 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5817 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5818
5819 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005820 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005821 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005822 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005823 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5824
5825 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5826 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005827 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005828 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005829
5830 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5831 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5832
5833
5834option clitcpka
5835no option clitcpka
5836 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5838 yes | yes | yes | no
5839 Arguments : none
5840
5841 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5842 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005843 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005844 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5845
5846 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5847 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5848 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5849 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5850
5851 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5852 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5853 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5854 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5855 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5856
5857 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5858
5859 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5860 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5861 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5862
5863 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5864 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5865
5866 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5867
5868
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005869option contstats
5870 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5872 yes | yes | yes | no
5873 Arguments : none
5874
5875 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5876 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5877 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5878 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005879 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5880 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5881 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5882 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5883 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005884
5885
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005886option dontlog-normal
5887no option dontlog-normal
5888 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5890 yes | yes | yes | no
5891 Arguments : none
5892
5893 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5894 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5895 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5896 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5897 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5898 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5899 logged.
5900
5901 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5902 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5903 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5904
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005905 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005906 logging.
5907
5908
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005909option dontlognull
5910no option dontlognull
5911 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5913 yes | yes | yes | no
5914 Arguments : none
5915
5916 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5917 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5918 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5919 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5920 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5921 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005922 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5923 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5924 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005925
5926 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005927 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005928 would not be logged.
5929
5930 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5931 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5932
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005933 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5934 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005935
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005936
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005937option forceclose (deprecated)
5938no option forceclose (deprecated)
5939 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005940
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005941 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005942
5943
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005944option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005945 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5947 yes | yes | yes | yes
5948 Arguments :
5949 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5950 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005951 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005952 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005953
5954 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5955 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5956 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5957 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5958 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5959 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5960 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005961 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5962 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5963 possible that the client has already brought one.
5964
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005965 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005966 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005967 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005968 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005969 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005970 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005971
5972 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5973 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5974 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5975 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5976 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5977 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5978 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5979
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005980 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5981 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5982 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5983 are under the control of the end-user.
5984
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005985 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005986 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5987 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005988 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5989 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5990 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005991
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005992 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005993 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5994 frontend www
5995 mode http
5996 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5997
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005998 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5999 backend www
6000 mode http
6001 option forwardfor header X-Client
6002
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006003 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006004 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006005
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006006
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006007option http-buffer-request
6008no option http-buffer-request
6009 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6011 yes | yes | yes | yes
6012 Arguments : none
6013
6014 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6015 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6016 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6017 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6018 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6019 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6020 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6021 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006022 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006023 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6024 default.
6025
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006026 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006027
6028
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006029option http-ignore-probes
6030no option http-ignore-probes
6031 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6033 yes | yes | yes | no
6034 Arguments : none
6035
6036 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6037 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6038 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6039 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6040 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6041 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6042 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6043 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6044 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006045 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6046 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006047 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6048
6049 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6050 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6051 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6052 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6053 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6054 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6055 are often the only way to detect them.
6056
6057 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6058 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6059
6060 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6061
6062
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006063option http-keep-alive
6064no option http-keep-alive
6065 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6067 yes | yes | yes | yes
6068 Arguments : none
6069
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006070 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6071 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006072 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6073 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6074 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6075 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6076 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006077
6078 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6079 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006080 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6081 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6082 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6083 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6084 situations where this option may be useful :
6085
6086 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006087 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006088
6089 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6090 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6091
6092 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6093 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6094 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6095 request.
6096
6097 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6098 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006099 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6100 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6101 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006102
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006103 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6104 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6105 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6106 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6107 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6108 not set.
6109
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006110 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006111 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6112 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006113
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006114 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006115 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006116 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006117
6118
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006119option http-no-delay
6120no option http-no-delay
6121 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6123 yes | yes | yes | yes
6124 Arguments : none
6125
6126 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6127 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6128 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6129 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6130 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6131 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6132 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6133 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6134 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6135 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6136 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6137 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6138 affected.
6139
6140 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6141 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6142 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6143 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6144 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6145 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6146 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6147 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6148 latency environments.
6149
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006150 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6151
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006152
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006153option http-pretend-keepalive
6154no option http-pretend-keepalive
6155 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006157 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006158 Arguments : none
6159
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006160 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006161 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6162 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6163 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6164 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6165 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6166 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6167 consider the response complete.
6168
6169 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6170 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6171 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6172 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006173 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006174 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6175
6176 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6177 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6178 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6179 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6180 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6181 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6182 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6183
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006184 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6185 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6186 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6187 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6188 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6189 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006190
6191 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6192 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6193
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006194 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006195 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006196
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006197
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006198option http-server-close
6199no option http-server-close
6200 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6202 yes | yes | yes | yes
6203 Arguments : none
6204
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006205 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6206 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6207 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6208 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006209 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6210 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6211 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6212 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6213 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6214 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6215 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6216 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6217 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6218 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6219 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006220
6221 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6222 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6223 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6224 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006225 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6226 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006227
6228 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6229 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006230 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6231 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6232 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006233
6234 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6235 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6236
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006237 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6238 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006239
6240
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006241option http-tunnel
6242no option http-tunnel
6243 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
6244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006245 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006246 Arguments : none
6247
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006248 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6249 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6250 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6251 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006252 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006253
6254 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006255 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006256 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6257 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6258 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6259 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6260 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6261 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6262 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006263
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006264 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6265 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6266 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6267 backend.
6268
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006269 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6270 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6271
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006272 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6273 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006274
6275
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006276option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006277no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006278 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6280 yes | yes | yes | no
6281 Arguments : none
6282
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006283 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006284 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6285 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6286 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6287 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6288 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6289 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6290
6291 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6292 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006293 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6294 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6295 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006296
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006297 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6298 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6299 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6300 front of an existing proxy.
6301
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006302 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6303
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006304 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006305
6306
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006307option http-use-htx
6308no option http-use-htx
6309 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6311 yes | yes | yes | yes
6312 Arguments : none
6313
6314 By default, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
6315 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
6316 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. Since this principle has deep
6317 roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being
6318 processed this way. It also results in the inability to establish HTTP/2
6319 connections to servers because of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1
6320 representation.
6321
6322 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6323 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6324 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6325 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
6326 most elements are directly accessed. This mechanism is still limited to the
6327 most basic operations (no compression, filters, Lua, applets, cache, etc).
6328 But it supports using either HTTP/1 or HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the
6329 other side's version.
6330
6331 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. It will cause errors to be
6332 emitted if incompatible features are used, but will allow H2 to be selected
6333 as a server protocol. It is recommended to use this option on new reasonably
6334 simple configurations, but since the feature still has incomplete functional
6335 coverage, it is not enabled by default.
6336
6337 See also : "mode http"
6338
6339
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006340option httpchk
6341option httpchk <uri>
6342option httpchk <method> <uri>
6343option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6344 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6346 yes | no | yes | yes
6347 Arguments :
6348 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6349 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6350 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6351 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6352 ones.
6353
6354 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6355 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6356 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6357
6358 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6359 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6360 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6361 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6362 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6363
6364 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6365 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6366 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6367 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6368 the lack of any response.
6369
6370 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6371
6372 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6373 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6374 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6375
6376 Examples :
6377 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6378 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6379 backend https_relay
6380 mode tcp
6381 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6382 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6383
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006384 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6385 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6386 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006387
6388
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006389option httpclose
6390no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006391 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6393 yes | yes | yes | yes
6394 Arguments : none
6395
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006396 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6397 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6398 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6399 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006400 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006401
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006402 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6403 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6404 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6405 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6406 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006407
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006408 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6409 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6410 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006411
6412 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6413 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006414 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006415 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6416 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6417 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006418
6419 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6420 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6421
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006422 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006423
6424
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006425option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006426 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006428 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006429 Arguments :
6430 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6431 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6432 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006433 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006434 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006435
6436 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6437 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6438 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6439 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6440 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6441 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6442 ports.
6443
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006444 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6445 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006446
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006447 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6448
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006449 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006450
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006451
6452option http_proxy
6453no option http_proxy
6454 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6456 yes | yes | yes | yes
6457 Arguments : none
6458
6459 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6460 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6461 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6462 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6463 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6464
6465 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6466 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006467 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6468 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006469
6470 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6471 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6472
6473 Example :
6474 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6475 backend direct_forward
6476 option httpclose
6477 option http_proxy
6478
6479 See also : "option httpclose"
6480
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006481
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006482option independent-streams
6483no option independent-streams
6484 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6486 yes | yes | yes | yes
6487 Arguments : none
6488
6489 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6490 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6491 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6492 receive data or not.
6493
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006494 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006495 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6496 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6497 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6498 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6499 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6500 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6501 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6502 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6503 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6504 socket buffers.
6505
6506 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6507 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6508 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6509 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6510 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6511
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006512 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006513 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6514 deprecated.
6515
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006516 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006517
6518
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006519option ldap-check
6520 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6522 yes | no | yes | yes
6523 Arguments : none
6524
6525 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6526 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6527 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6528 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6529
6530 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6531 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6532
6533 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6534 configure it.
6535
6536 Example :
6537 option ldap-check
6538
6539 See also : "option httpchk"
6540
6541
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006542option external-check
6543 Use external processes for server health checks
6544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6545 yes | no | yes | yes
6546
6547 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6548 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6549 command".
6550
6551 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6552
6553 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6554
6555
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006556option log-health-checks
6557no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006558 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6560 yes | no | yes | yes
6561 Arguments : none
6562
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006563 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6564 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6565 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006566
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006567 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6568 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6569 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6570 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6571 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6572
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006573 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006574 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006575
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006576 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6577 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6578 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006579
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006580
6581option log-separate-errors
6582no option log-separate-errors
6583 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6585 yes | yes | yes | no
6586 Arguments : none
6587
6588 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6589 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6590 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6591 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6592 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6593 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6594 provides very important information.
6595
6596 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6597 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6598 error logs.
6599
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006600 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006601 logging.
6602
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006603
6604option logasap
6605no option logasap
6606 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6608 yes | yes | yes | no
6609 Arguments : none
6610
6611 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6612 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6613 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6614 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6615 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6616 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6617 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006618 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006619 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6620 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6621
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006622 Examples :
6623 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6624 mode http
6625 option httplog
6626 option logasap
6627 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6628
6629 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6630 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6631 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6632 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6633
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006634 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006635 logging.
6636
6637
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006638option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006639 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6641 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006642 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006643 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6644 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006645 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006646
6647 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6648 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006649 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006650 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6651 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6652 in the MySQL table, like this :
6653
6654 USE mysql;
6655 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6656 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6657
6658 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006659 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006660 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6661 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6662 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6663 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6664 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6665 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6666 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6667
6668 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6669 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006670
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006671 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006672
6673 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6674 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6675 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6676 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006677 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6678 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006679
6680 See also: "option httpchk"
6681
6682
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006683option nolinger
6684no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006685 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006686 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6687 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006688 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006689
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006690 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006691 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6692 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6693 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6694 connections.
6695
6696 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6697 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6698 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6699 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6700 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6701 this too.
6702
6703 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6704 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6705 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6706
6707 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6708 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6709 for servers.
6710
6711 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6712 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6713
6714
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006715option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6716 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6718 yes | yes | yes | yes
6719 Arguments :
6720 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6721 matching <network>
6722 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6723 header name.
6724
6725 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6726 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6727 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6728 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6729 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6730 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6731 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6732 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6733 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6734 possible that the client has already brought one.
6735
6736 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6737 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6738 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6739 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6740 header and requires different one.
6741
6742 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6743 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6744 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6745 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6746 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6747 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6748 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6749
6750 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6751 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6752 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6753 both are defined.
6754
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006755 Examples :
6756 # Original Destination address
6757 frontend www
6758 mode http
6759 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6760
6761 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6762 backend www
6763 mode http
6764 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6765
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006766 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006767
6768
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006769option persist
6770no option persist
6771 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6772 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6773 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006774 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006775
6776 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6777 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6778 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6779 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6780 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6781 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6782 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6783 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6784 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6785 redirected to another valid server.
6786
6787 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6788 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6789
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006790 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006791
6792
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006793option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6794 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6796 yes | no | yes | yes
6797 Arguments :
6798 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6799 PostgreSQL server.
6800
6801 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6802 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6803 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6804 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6805
6806 See also: "option httpchk"
6807
6808
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006809option prefer-last-server
6810no option prefer-last-server
6811 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6812 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6813 yes | no | yes | yes
6814 Arguments : none
6815
6816 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6817 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6818 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6819 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6820 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6821 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6822 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6823 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6824 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006825 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6826 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006827 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6828 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6829 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006830 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6831 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6832 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006833
6834 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6835 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6836
6837 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6838
6839
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006840option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006841option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006842no option redispatch
6843 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6844 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6845 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006846 Arguments :
6847 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6848 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6849 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006850 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006851 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006852 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006853 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6854 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6855 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6856
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006857
6858 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6859 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6860 be able to access the service anymore.
6861
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006862 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6863 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006864
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006865 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006866 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6867 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006868
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006869 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6870 "redisp" keywords.
6871
6872 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6873 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6874
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006875 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006876
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006877
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006878option redis-check
6879 Use redis health checks for server testing
6880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6881 yes | no | yes | yes
6882 Arguments : none
6883
6884 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6885 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6886 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6887 find the "+PONG" response message.
6888
6889 Example :
6890 option redis-check
6891
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006892 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006893
6894
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006895option smtpchk
6896option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6897 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6899 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006900 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006901 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006902 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006903 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6904
6905 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6906 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6907 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6908
6909 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6910 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6911 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6912 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6913 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6914 dead server.
6915
6916 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6917 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006918 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006919 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6920
6921 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6922 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6923 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6924 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006925 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006926
6927 Example :
6928 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6929
6930 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6931
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006932
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006933option socket-stats
6934no option socket-stats
6935
6936 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6938 yes | yes | yes | no
6939
6940 Arguments : none
6941
6942
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006943option splice-auto
6944no option splice-auto
6945 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6947 yes | yes | yes | yes
6948 Arguments : none
6949
6950 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6951 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006952 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006953 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006954 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006955 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6956 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6957 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6958 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6959
6960 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6961 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6962 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6963 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6964 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6965 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6966 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6967 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6968 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6969 keyword.
6970
6971 Example :
6972 option splice-auto
6973
6974 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6975 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6976
6977 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6978 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6979
6980
6981option splice-request
6982no option splice-request
6983 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6985 yes | yes | yes | yes
6986 Arguments : none
6987
6988 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006989 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006990 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6991 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6992 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6993 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6994
6995 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6996
6997 Example :
6998 option splice-request
6999
7000 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7001 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7002
7003 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7004 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7005
7006
7007option splice-response
7008no option splice-response
7009 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7011 yes | yes | yes | yes
7012 Arguments : none
7013
7014 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007015 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007016 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7017 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7018 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7019 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7020
7021 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7022
7023 Example :
7024 option splice-response
7025
7026 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7027 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7028
7029 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7030 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7031
7032
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007033option spop-check
7034 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7036 no | no | no | yes
7037 Arguments : none
7038
7039 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7040 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7041 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7042 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7043
7044 Example :
7045 option spop-check
7046
7047 See also : "option httpchk"
7048
7049
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007050option srvtcpka
7051no option srvtcpka
7052 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7054 yes | no | yes | yes
7055 Arguments : none
7056
7057 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7058 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007059 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007060 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7061
7062 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7063 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7064 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7065 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7066
7067 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7068 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7069 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7070 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7071 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7072
7073 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7074
7075 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7076 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7077 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7078
7079 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7080 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7081
7082 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7083
7084
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007085option ssl-hello-chk
7086 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7088 yes | no | yes | yes
7089 Arguments : none
7090
7091 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7092 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7093 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7094 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7095 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7096 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7097 hello message.
7098
7099 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7100 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7101 messages, which is appreciable.
7102
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007103 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7104 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7105 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007106
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007107 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7108
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007109
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007110option tcp-check
7111 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7112 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7113 yes | no | yes | yes
7114
7115 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7116 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7117
7118 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7119 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7120 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7121
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007122 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007123 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7124 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7125 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7126 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7127 only.
7128
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007129 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007130 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7131 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7132 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7133 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7134
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007135 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007136 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7137 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007138 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007139 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7140 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7141 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7142 the respective protocols.
7143 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007144 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007145
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007146 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7147 script.
7148
7149 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7150 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7151 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7152 The "comment" is of course optional.
7153
7154
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007155 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007156 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007157 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007158 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007159
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007160 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007161 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007162 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007163
7164 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7165 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007166 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007167 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007168 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007169 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007170 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007171 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007172 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7173 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007174 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007175 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7176 tcp-check expect string +OK
7177
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007178 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007179 (send many headers before analyzing)
7180 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007181 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007182 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7183 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7184 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7185 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007186 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007187
7188
7189 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7190
7191
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007192option tcp-smart-accept
7193no option tcp-smart-accept
7194 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7196 yes | yes | yes | no
7197 Arguments : none
7198
7199 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7200 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7201 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7202 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7203 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7204 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7205
7206 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7207 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7208 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7209 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7210
7211 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7212 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7213 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007214 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007215
7216 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7217 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7218 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7219
7220 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7221 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7222 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7223
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007224 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7225
7226
7227option tcp-smart-connect
7228no option tcp-smart-connect
7229 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7231 yes | no | yes | yes
7232 Arguments : none
7233
7234 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7235 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7236 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7237 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7238 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7239
7240 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7241 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7242 complex.
7243
7244 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7245 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7246 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7247
7248 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7249 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7250
7251 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7252
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007253
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007254option tcpka
7255 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7257 yes | yes | yes | yes
7258 Arguments : none
7259
7260 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7261 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007262 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007263 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7264
7265 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7266 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7267 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7268 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7269
7270 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7271 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7272 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7273 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7274 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7275
7276 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7277
7278 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7279 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7280 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7281 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7282 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7283 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7284 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7285 backends.
7286
7287 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7288
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007289
7290option tcplog
7291 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007293 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007294 Arguments : none
7295
7296 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7297 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7298 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7299 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7300 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7301 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7302 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7303 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7304
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007305 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7306
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007307 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007308
7309
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007310option transparent
7311no option transparent
7312 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007314 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007315 Arguments : none
7316
7317 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7318 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7319 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7320 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7321 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7322 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7323 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7324 appropriate server.
7325
7326 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7327 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7328
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007329 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007330 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007331
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007332
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007333external-check command <command>
7334 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7336 yes | no | yes | yes
7337
7338 Arguments :
7339 <command> is the external command to run
7340
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007341 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7342
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007343 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007344
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007345 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7346 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7347 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7348 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7349 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7350 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007351
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007352 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7353
7354 Environment variables :
7355 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7356 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7357
7358 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7359
7360 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7361
7362 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7363 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7364 for a UNIX socket).
7365
7366 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7367
7368 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7369
7370 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7371
7372 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7373
7374 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7375
7376 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7377 socket).
7378
7379 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7380 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7381
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007382 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7383 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7384 failed.
7385
7386 Example :
7387 external-check command /bin/true
7388
7389 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7390
7391
7392external-check path <path>
7393 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7395 yes | no | yes | yes
7396
7397 Arguments :
7398 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7399
7400 The default path is "".
7401
7402 Example :
7403 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7404
7405 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7406 "external-check command"
7407
7408
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007409persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007410persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007411 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7413 yes | no | yes | yes
7414 Arguments :
7415 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007416 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7417 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007418
7419 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7420 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007421 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007422 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7423 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7424 forwarded to this server.
7425
7426 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7427 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7428 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007429 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007430 a single "listen" section.
7431
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007432 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7433 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7434 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7435
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007436 Example :
7437 listen tse-farm
7438 bind :3389
7439 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7440 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7441 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7442 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7443 persist rdp-cookie
7444 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007445 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007446 balance rdp-cookie
7447 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7448 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7449
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007450 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7451 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007452
7453
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007454rate-limit sessions <rate>
7455 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7457 yes | yes | yes | no
7458 Arguments :
7459 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7460 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7461
7462 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7463 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7464 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7465 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7466 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7467 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7468
7469 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7470 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7471 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7472 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7473
7474 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7475 listen smtp
7476 mode tcp
7477 bind :25
7478 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007479 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007480
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007481 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7482 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7483 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007484
7485 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7486
7487
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007488redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7489redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7490redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007491 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7493 no | yes | yes | yes
7494
7495 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007496 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007497
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007498 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007499 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007500 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7501 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7502 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007503
7504 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7505 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7506 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7507 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7508 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007509 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7510 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7511 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7512 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007513
7514 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7515 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7516 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7517 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7518 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7519 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007520 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007521 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007522 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7523 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7524 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007525
7526 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007527 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7528 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7529 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007530 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007531 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7532 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7533 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7534 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007535
7536 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007537 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007538
7539 - "drop-query"
7540 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7541 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7542 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7543 with a location-type redirect.
7544
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007545 - "append-slash"
7546 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7547 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7548 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7549 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7550
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007551 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7552 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7553 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7554 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7555 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7556 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7557 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7558
7559 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7560 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7561 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7562 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7563 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7564 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7565 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007566
7567 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7568 acl clear dst_port 80
7569 acl secure dst_port 8080
7570 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007571 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007572 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007573 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7574
7575 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007576 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7577 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7578 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007579 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007580
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007581 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7582 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7583 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7584
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007585 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007586 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007587
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007588 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007589 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7590 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7591 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007593 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007594
7595
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007596redisp (deprecated)
7597redispatch (deprecated)
7598 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7599 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7600 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007601 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007602
7603 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7604 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7605 be able to access the service anymore.
7606
7607 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7608 redistribute them to a working server.
7609
7610 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7611 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7612 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007613
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007614 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7615 "option redispatch" instead.
7616
7617 See also : "option redispatch"
7618
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007619
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007620reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007621 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7623 no | yes | yes | yes
7624 Arguments :
7625 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7626 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007627 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007628
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007629 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7630 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7631
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007632 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7633 the last header of an HTTP request.
7634
7635 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7636 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7637 responses.
7638
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007639 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7640 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7641 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7642
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007643 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7644 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007645
7646
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007647reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7648reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007649 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7651 no | yes | yes | yes
7652 Arguments :
7653 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7654 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7655 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7656 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7657 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7658 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7659 ignores case.
7660
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007661 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7662 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7663
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007664 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7665 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7666 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7667 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007668 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007669
7670 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7671 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7672
7673 Example :
7674 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7675 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7676 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7677
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007678 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7679 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007680
7681
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007682reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7683reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007684 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7686 no | yes | yes | yes
7687 Arguments :
7688 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7689 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7690 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7691 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7692 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7693 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7694
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007695 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7696 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7697
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007698 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7699 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7700 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7701 next servers.
7702
7703 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7704 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7705 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7706
7707 Example :
7708 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7709 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7710 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7711
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007712 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7713 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007714
7715
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007716reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7717reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007718 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7720 no | yes | yes | yes
7721 Arguments :
7722 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7723 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7724 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7725 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7726 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7727 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7728 case.
7729
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007730 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7731 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7732
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007733 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7734 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7735 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7736 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007737 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007738
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007739 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007740 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007741 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007742
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007743 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7744 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7745
7746 Example :
7747 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7748 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7749 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7750
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007751 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7752 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007753
7754
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007755reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7756reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007757 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7759 no | yes | yes | yes
7760 Arguments :
7761 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7762 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7763 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7764 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7765 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7766 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7767 case.
7768
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007769 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7770 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7771
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007772 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7773 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7774 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7775 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7776
7777 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7778 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7779
7780 Example :
7781 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7782 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7783 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7784 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7785
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007786 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7787 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007788
7789
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007790reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7791reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007792 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7794 no | yes | yes | yes
7795 Arguments :
7796 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7797 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7798 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7799 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7800 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7801 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7802
7803 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7804 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7805 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7806 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007807 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007808
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007809 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7810 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7811
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007812 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7813 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7814 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7815
7816 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7817 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7818 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7819 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7820 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7821
7822 Example :
7823 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007824 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007825 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7826 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7827
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007828 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7829 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007830
7831
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007832reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7833reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007834 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7836 no | yes | yes | yes
7837 Arguments :
7838 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7839 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7840 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7841 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7842 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7843 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7844 ignores case.
7845
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007846 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7847 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7848
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007849 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7850 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007851 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7852 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7853 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007854 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7855 not set.
7856
7857 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7858 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7859 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7860 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7861 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7862
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007863 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007864 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007865 # block all others.
7866 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7867 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7868
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007869 # block bad guys
7870 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7871 reqitarpit . if badguys
7872
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007873 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7874 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007875
7876
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007877retries <value>
7878 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7880 yes | no | yes | yes
7881 Arguments :
7882 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7883 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7884 default value is 3.
7885
7886 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7887 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7888 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7889
7890 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007891 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7892 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007893
7894 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7895 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7896
7897 See also : "option redispatch"
7898
7899
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007900rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007901 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7903 no | yes | yes | yes
7904 Arguments :
7905 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7906 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007907 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007908
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007909 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7910 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7911
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007912 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7913 the last header of an HTTP response.
7914
7915 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7916 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7917 responses.
7918
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007919 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7920 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007921
7922
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007923rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7924rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007925 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7927 no | yes | yes | yes
7928 Arguments :
7929 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7930 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7931 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7932 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7933 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7934 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7935 ignores case.
7936
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007937 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7938 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7939
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007940 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7941 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007942 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007943 client.
7944
7945 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7946 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7947 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7948
7949 Example :
7950 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007951 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007952
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007953 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7954 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007955
7956
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007957rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7958rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007959 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7961 no | yes | yes | yes
7962 Arguments :
7963 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7964 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7965 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7966 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7967 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7968 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7969 ignores case.
7970
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007971 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7972 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7973
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007974 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7975 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7976 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7977 case-sensitive.
7978
7979 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007980 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7981 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7982 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007983
7984 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7985 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7986
7987 Example :
7988 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7989 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7990
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007991 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7992 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007993
7994
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007995rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7996rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007997 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7999 no | yes | yes | yes
8000 Arguments :
8001 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8002 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8003 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8004 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8005 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8006 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8007 ignores case.
8008
8009 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8010 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8011 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8012 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008013 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008014
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008015 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8016 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8017
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008018 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8019 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8020 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8021
8022 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8023 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8024 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8025 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8026 are not case-sensitive.
8027
8028 Example :
8029 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8030 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8031
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008032 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8033 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008034
8035
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008036server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008037 Declare a server in a backend
8038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8039 no | no | yes | yes
8040 Arguments :
8041 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008042 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008043 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008044
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008045 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8046 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8047 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8048 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008049 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8050 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8051 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8052 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8053 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008054 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8055 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8056 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8057 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8058 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8059 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8060 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008061 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008062 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8063 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8064 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8065 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8066 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8067 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008068 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8069 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008070 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8071 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008072
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008073 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008074 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8075 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8076 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8077 adding this value to the client's port.
8078
8079 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8080 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008081 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008082
8083 Examples :
8084 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8085 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008086 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008087 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8088 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8089 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008090
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008091 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8092 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8093 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8094 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8095 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8096
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008097 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8098 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008099
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008100server-state-file-name [<file>]
8101 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8102 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8103 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8104 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8105 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8106 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8107
8108 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8109 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8110
8111 global
8112 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8113
8114 backend bk
8115 load-server-state-from-file
8116
8117 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8118 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008119
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008120server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8121 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8122 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8124 no | no | yes | yes
8125
8126 Arguments:
8127 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8128
8129 <num | range>
8130 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8131 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8132 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8133 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8134
8135 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8136
8137 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8138
8139 <params*>
8140 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8141 keyword.
8142
8143 Examples:
8144 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8145 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8146 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8147
8148 # or
8149 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8150
8151 # would be equivalent to:
8152 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8153 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8154 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8155
8156
8157
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008158source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008159source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008160source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008161 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8163 yes | no | yes | yes
8164 Arguments :
8165 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8166 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008167
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008168 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008169 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8170 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8171 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8172 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8173 supported prefixes are :
8174 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8175 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8176 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008177 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008178 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8179 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008180
8181 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8182 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008183 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8184 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8185 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008186
8187 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8188 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8189 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8190 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8191 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8192 <addr>.
8193
8194 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8195 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8196 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8197 port.
8198
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008199 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8200 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8201 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8202 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008203 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008204 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8205 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8206 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8207 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8208 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8209 HTTP header.
8210
8211 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8212 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008213 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008214 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8215 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8216 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8217 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8218 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8219 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8220 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8221
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008222 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8223 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8224 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8225 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8226 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8227 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8228
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008229 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8230 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8231 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8232 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8233
8234 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8235 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8236 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8237 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8238 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8239 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8240
8241 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8242 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8243 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8244 there are two methods :
8245
8246 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8247 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8248 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8249 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8250 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8251 of the client ranges may be used.
8252
8253 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8254 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8255 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8256 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8257 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8258 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8259 same session.
8260
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008261 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8262 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8263 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008264 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008265
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008266 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8267
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008268 Examples :
8269 backend private
8270 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8271 source 192.168.1.200
8272
8273 backend transparent_ssl1
8274 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8275 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8276
8277 backend transparent_ssl2
8278 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8279 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8280 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8281
8282 backend transparent_ssl3
8283 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8284 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8285 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8286
8287 backend transparent_smtp
8288 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8289 # with Tproxy version 4.
8290 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8291
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008292 backend transparent_http
8293 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8294 # proxy.
8295 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008297 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008298 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8299
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008300
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008301srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8302 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8304 yes | no | yes | yes
8305 Arguments :
8306 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8307 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8308 as explained at the top of this document.
8309
8310 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8311 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8312 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8313 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8314 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8315 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8316 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8317
8318 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8319 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8320 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8321 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8322 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008323 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008324 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008325 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008326
8327 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8328 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8329 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8330 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8331 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8332 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8333
8334 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8335 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8336
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008337 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8338 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008339
8340
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008341stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8342 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008344 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008345
8346 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8347 matched.
8348
8349 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8350 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8351
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008352 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8353 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008354 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008355
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008356 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8357 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8358 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8359 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008360
8361 Example :
8362 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8363 backend stats_localhost
8364 stats enable
8365 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8366
8367 Example :
8368 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8369 backend stats_auth
8370 stats enable
8371 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8372 stats admin if TRUE
8373
8374 Example :
8375 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8376 userlist stats-auth
8377 group admin users admin
8378 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8379 group readonly users haproxy
8380 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8381
8382 backend stats_auth
8383 stats enable
8384 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8385 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8386 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8387 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8388
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008389 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8390 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8391 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008392
8393
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008394stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8395 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008397 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008398 Arguments :
8399 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8400
8401 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8402
8403 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8404 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8405 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8406 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8407 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8408 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8409
8410 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8411 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8412 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008413 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008414
8415 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8416 report using "stats scope".
8417
8418 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8419 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8420 unobvious parameters.
8421
8422 Example :
8423 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8424 backend public_www
8425 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8426 stats enable
8427 stats hide-version
8428 stats scope .
8429 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008430 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008431 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8432 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8433
8434 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8435 backend private_monitoring
8436 stats enable
8437 stats uri /admin?stats
8438 stats refresh 5s
8439
8440 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8441
8442
8443stats enable
8444 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008446 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008447 Arguments : none
8448
8449 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8450 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8451 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8452 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8453 - stats auth : no authentication
8454 - stats scope : no restriction
8455
8456 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8457 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8458 unobvious parameters.
8459
8460 Example :
8461 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8462 backend public_www
8463 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8464 stats enable
8465 stats hide-version
8466 stats scope .
8467 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008468 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008469 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8470 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8471
8472 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8473 backend private_monitoring
8474 stats enable
8475 stats uri /admin?stats
8476 stats refresh 5s
8477
8478 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8479
8480
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008481stats hide-version
8482 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008484 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008485 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008486
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008487 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8488 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8489 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8490 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8491 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8492 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008493
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008494 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8495 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8496 unobvious parameters.
8497
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008498 Example :
8499 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8500 backend public_www
8501 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008502 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008503 stats hide-version
8504 stats scope .
8505 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008506 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008507 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8508 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008509
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008510 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8511 backend private_monitoring
8512 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008513 stats uri /admin?stats
8514 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008515
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008516 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008517
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008518
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008519stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8520 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8521 Access control for statistics
8522
8523 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8524 no | no | yes | yes
8525
8526 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8527 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8528 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8529 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8530 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8531 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8532
8533 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8534 instance.
8535
8536 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8537 about ACL usage.
8538
8539
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008540stats realm <realm>
8541 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008543 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008544 Arguments :
8545 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8546 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8547 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8548
8549 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8550 using a backslash ('\').
8551
8552 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8553 only related to authentication.
8554
8555 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8556 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8557 unobvious parameters.
8558
8559 Example :
8560 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8561 backend public_www
8562 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8563 stats enable
8564 stats hide-version
8565 stats scope .
8566 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008567 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008568 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8569 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8570
8571 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8572 backend private_monitoring
8573 stats enable
8574 stats uri /admin?stats
8575 stats refresh 5s
8576
8577 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8578
8579
8580stats refresh <delay>
8581 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008583 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008584 Arguments :
8585 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8586 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8587 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8588 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8589 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8590 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8591
8592 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8593 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8594 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8595 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8596
8597 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8598 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8599 unobvious parameters.
8600
8601 Example :
8602 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8603 backend public_www
8604 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8605 stats enable
8606 stats hide-version
8607 stats scope .
8608 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008609 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008610 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8611 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8612
8613 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8614 backend private_monitoring
8615 stats enable
8616 stats uri /admin?stats
8617 stats refresh 5s
8618
8619 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8620
8621
8622stats scope { <name> | "." }
8623 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008625 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008626 Arguments :
8627 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8628 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8629 section in which the statement appears.
8630
8631 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8632 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8633 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8634 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8635 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8636 exists.
8637
8638 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8639 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8640 unobvious parameters.
8641
8642 Example :
8643 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8644 backend public_www
8645 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8646 stats enable
8647 stats hide-version
8648 stats scope .
8649 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008650 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008651 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8652 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8653
8654 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8655 backend private_monitoring
8656 stats enable
8657 stats uri /admin?stats
8658 stats refresh 5s
8659
8660 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8661
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008662
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008663stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008664 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008666 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008667
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008668 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008669 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8670
8671 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8672 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8673
8674 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8675 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008676 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008677
8678 Example :
8679 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8680 backend private_monitoring
8681 stats enable
8682 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8683 stats uri /admin?stats
8684 stats refresh 5s
8685
8686 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8687 global section.
8688
8689
8690stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008691 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8693 yes | yes | yes | yes
8694 Arguments : none
8695
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008696 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008697 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8698 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8699 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8700 - IP (socket, server)
8701 - cookie (backend, server)
8702
8703 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8704 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008705 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008706
8707 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8708
8709
8710stats show-node [ <name> ]
8711 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008713 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008714 Arguments:
8715 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8716 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8717
8718 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8719 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008720 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008721
8722 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8723 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8724 unobvious parameters.
8725
8726 Example:
8727 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8728 backend private_monitoring
8729 stats enable
8730 stats show-node Europe-1
8731 stats uri /admin?stats
8732 stats refresh 5s
8733
8734 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8735 section.
8736
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008737
8738stats uri <prefix>
8739 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008741 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008742 Arguments :
8743 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8744 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8745 query string.
8746
8747 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8748 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8749 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8750 possible to reach it in the application.
8751
8752 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008753 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008754 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8755 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8756 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8757 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8758
8759 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8760 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8761 an address or a port to statistics only.
8762
8763 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8764 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8765 unobvious parameters.
8766
8767 Example :
8768 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8769 backend public_www
8770 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8771 stats enable
8772 stats hide-version
8773 stats scope .
8774 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008775 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008776 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8777 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8778
8779 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8780 backend private_monitoring
8781 stats enable
8782 stats uri /admin?stats
8783 stats refresh 5s
8784
8785 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8786
8787
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008788stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8789 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008791 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008792
8793 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008794 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008795 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008796 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008797 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8798
8799 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8800 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8801 the "stick-table" statement.
8802
8803 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8804 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8805 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8806 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8807 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8808
8809 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8810 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8811 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8812 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8813 transformation rules.
8814
8815 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8816 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8817 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8818 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8819 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8820 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8821 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8822
8823 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8824 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8825 ACL based conditions.
8826
8827 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8828 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8829 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8830 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8831
8832 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8833 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8834 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8835 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8836
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008837 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8838 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008839 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008840
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008841 Example :
8842 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8843 # last 30 minutes
8844 backend pop
8845 mode tcp
8846 balance roundrobin
8847 stick store-request src
8848 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8849 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8850 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8851
8852 backend smtp
8853 mode tcp
8854 balance roundrobin
8855 stick match src table pop
8856 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8857 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8858
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008859 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008860 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008861
8862
8863stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8864 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8866 no | no | yes | yes
8867
8868 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8869 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8870 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8871 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8872
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008873 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8874 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008875 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008876
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008877 Examples :
8878 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008879 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008880
8881 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8882 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8883 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8884
8885
8886 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8887 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8888 backend http
8889 mode http
8890 balance roundrobin
8891 stick on src table https
8892 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8893 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8894 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8895
8896 backend https
8897 mode tcp
8898 balance roundrobin
8899 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8900 stick on src
8901 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8902 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8903
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008904 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008905
8906
8907stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8908 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8910 no | no | yes | yes
8911
8912 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008913 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008914 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008915 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008916 server is selected.
8917
8918 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8919 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8920 the "stick-table" statement.
8921
8922 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8923 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8924 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8925 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8926 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8927 address.
8928
8929 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8930 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8931 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8932 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8933 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8934 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8935 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8936 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8937 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8938 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8939
8940 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8941 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8942 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8943 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8944 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8945 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8946 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8947
8948 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8949 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8950 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8951 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8952
8953 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8954 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8955 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8956 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8957 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8958 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008959 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8960 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8961 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8962 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8963 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8964 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008965
8966 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8967 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8968 the request.
8969
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008970 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8971 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008972 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008973
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008974 Example :
8975 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8976 # last 30 minutes
8977 backend pop
8978 mode tcp
8979 balance roundrobin
8980 stick store-request src
8981 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8982 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8983 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8984
8985 backend smtp
8986 mode tcp
8987 balance roundrobin
8988 stick match src table pop
8989 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8990 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8991
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008992 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008993 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008994
8995
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008996stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008997 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8998 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008999 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009001 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009002
9003 Arguments :
9004 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9005 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9006 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9007 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9008
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009009 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9010 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9011 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9012 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9013
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009014 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9015 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9016 instance.
9017
9018 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9019 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9020 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9021 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9022 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9023 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009024 to 32 characters.
9025
9026 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9027 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9028 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009029 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009030 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9031 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009032
9033 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009034 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9035 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009036 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9037 increase.
9038
9039 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009040 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9041 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9042 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009043
9044 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9045 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9046 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9047 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009048 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009049 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9050 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9051 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9052 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9053 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9054 parameter (see below).
9055
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009056 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9057 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9058 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9059 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9060 soft restart.
9061
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009062 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9063 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009064
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009065 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9066 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9067 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9068 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009069 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009070 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009071 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9072 if not expiration delay is specified.
9073
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009074 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9075 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9076 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9077 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009078 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9079 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9080 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9081 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9082 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9083 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9084 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9085 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9086 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9087 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9088 types and their arguments.
9089
9090 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9091 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9092 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9093 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9094
9095 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9096 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9097 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009098 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009099
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009100 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9101 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9102 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009103 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009104 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009105 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009106
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009107 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9108 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9109 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9110 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9111
9112 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9113 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9114 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9115 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9116 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9117 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9118
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009119 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9120 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9121 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9122 they were received.
9123
9124 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9125 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9126 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9127 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9128 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9129
9130 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9131 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9132 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9133 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9134 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9135
9136 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9137 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9138 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9139
9140 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9141 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9142 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9143 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9144 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9145
9146 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9147 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9148 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9149 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9150 the client side.
9151
9152 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9153 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9154 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9155 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9156 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9157 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9158 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9159
9160 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9161 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9162 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9163 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9164 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9165 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009166 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009167
9168 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9169 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9170 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9171 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9172 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9173 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9174
9175 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009176 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009177 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9178 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9179
9180 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9181 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9182 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9183 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9184 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9185 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9186 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9187 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9188 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9189 recommended for better fairness.
9190
9191 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009192 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009193 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9194 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9195
9196 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9197 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9198 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9199 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9200 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9201 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9202 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9203 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9204 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9205 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009206
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009207 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9208 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009209 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9210 reference it.
9211
9212 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9213 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009214 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9215 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9216 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009217
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009218 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9219 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9220 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9221 something that can be ignored.
9222
9223 Example:
9224 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9225 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9226 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9227 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9228
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009229 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009230 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009231
9232
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009233stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009234 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9236 no | no | yes | yes
9237
9238 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009239 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009240 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009241 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009242 server is selected.
9243
9244 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9245 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9246 the "stick-table" statement.
9247
9248 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9249 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9250 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9251 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9252
9253 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9254 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9255 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9256 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9257 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9258 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009259 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009260 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9261 rules.
9262
9263 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9264 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9265 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9266 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9267 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9268 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9269 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9270
9271 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9272 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9273 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9274 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9275
9276 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9277 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9278 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9279 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9280 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9281 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009282 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9283 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9284 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9285 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9286 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9287 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9288 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9289 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9290 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009291
9292 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9293
9294 Example :
9295 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9296 backend https
9297 mode tcp
9298 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009299 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009300 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009301
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009302 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9303 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9304
9305 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9306 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9307 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9308
9309 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9310 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009311
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009312 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9313 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9314 # at offset 44.
9315
9316 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9317 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9318
9319 # Learn on response if server hello.
9320 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009321
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009322 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9323 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9324
9325 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9326 extraction.
9327
9328
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009329tcp-check connect [params*]
9330 Opens a new connection
9331 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9332 no | no | yes | yes
9333
9334 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9335 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9336 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9337
9338 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9339 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9340 of the sequence.
9341
9342 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9343 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9344 do.
9345
9346 Parameters :
9347 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9348 use the TCP connection.
9349
9350 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9351 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9352 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9353
9354 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9355
9356 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9357
9358 Examples:
9359 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9360 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9361 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9362 option tcp-check
9363 tcp-check connect
9364 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9365 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9366 tcp-check send \r\n
9367 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9368 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9369 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9370 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9371 tcp-check send \r\n
9372 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9373 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9374
9375 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9376 option tcp-check
9377 tcp-check connect port 110
9378 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9379 tcp-check connect port 143
9380 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9381 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9382
9383 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9384
9385
9386tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009387 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009388 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9389 no | no | yes | yes
9390
9391 Arguments :
9392 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9393 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9394 binary.
9395 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9396 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9397 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9398
9399 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9400 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9401 with the usual backslash ('\').
9402 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009403 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009404 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9405 used upper or lower case.
9406
9407
9408 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9409
9410 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9411 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9412 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9413 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9414 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9415 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9416 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9417 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9418
9419 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9420 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9421 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9422 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9423 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9424 expression.
9425
9426 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9427 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9428 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9429 this exact hexadecimal string.
9430 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9431
9432 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9433 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9434 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9435 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9436 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9437 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9438 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9439 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9440 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9441 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9442 the null character.
9443
9444 Examples :
9445 # perform a POP check
9446 option tcp-check
9447 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9448
9449 # perform an IMAP check
9450 option tcp-check
9451 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9452
9453 # look for the redis master server
9454 option tcp-check
9455 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009456 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009457 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9458 tcp-check expect string role:master
9459 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9460 tcp-check expect string +OK
9461
9462
9463 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9464 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9465
9466
9467tcp-check send <data>
9468 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9469 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9470 no | no | yes | yes
9471
9472 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9473 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9474
9475 Examples :
9476 # look for the redis master server
9477 option tcp-check
9478 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9479 tcp-check expect string role:master
9480
9481 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9482 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9483
9484
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009485tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9486 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009487 tcp health check
9488 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9489 no | no | yes | yes
9490
9491 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9492 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009493 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009494 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9495 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9496 hexadecimal string.
9497 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9498
9499 Examples :
9500 # redis check in binary
9501 option tcp-check
9502 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9503 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9504
9505
9506 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9507 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9508
9509
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009510tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9511 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9513 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009514 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009515 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9516 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009517
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009518 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009519
9520 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9521 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009522 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9523 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9524 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9525 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9526 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9527 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009528
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009529 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9530 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9531 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9532 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009533
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009534 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009535 - accept :
9536 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9537 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9538 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009539
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009540 - reject :
9541 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9542 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9543 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9544 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9545 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9546 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9547 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9548 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9549 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9550 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9551 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009552 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009553
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009554 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9555 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9556 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9557 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9558 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9559 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9560 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9561 hosts.
9562
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009563 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9564 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9565 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9566 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9567 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9568 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9569 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9570 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9571
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009572 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9573 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9574 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9575 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9576 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9577 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9578 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9579 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9580 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009581 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9582 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009583
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009584 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009585 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009586 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9587 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9588 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9589 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9590 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9591 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9592 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9593 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9594 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9595 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9596 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9597 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009598
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009599 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009600 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009601 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009602 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009603 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9604 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9605 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009606
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009607 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9608 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9609 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9610 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009611
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009612 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9613 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9614 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9615 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9616 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009617 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9618 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9619 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9620 layer7 information is extracted.
9621
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009622 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9623 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9624 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9625 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9626 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009627
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009628 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9629 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9630 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9631 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9632
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009633 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9634 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9635 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9636 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9637
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009638 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9639 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9640 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9641 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9642 continues.
9643
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009644 - set-src <expr> :
9645 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9646 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9647 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009648 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009649
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009650 Arguments:
9651 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9652 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009653
9654 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009655 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9656
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009657 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9658 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009659
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009660 - set-src-port <expr> :
9661 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9662 expression.
9663
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009664 Arguments:
9665 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9666 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009667
9668 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009669 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9670
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009671 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9672 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9673 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009674
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009675 - set-dst <expr> :
9676 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9677 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9678 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9679 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9680 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9681
9682 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9683 followed by some converters.
9684
9685 Example:
9686
9687 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9688 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9689
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009690 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9691 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9692
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009693 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9694 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9695 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9696 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9697
9698
9699 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9700 followed by some converters.
9701
9702 Example:
9703
9704 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9705
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009706 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9707 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9708 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9709
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009710 - "silent-drop" :
9711 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009712 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009713 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9714 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9715 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9716 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9717 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009718 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9719 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009720 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9721 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009722 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009723 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9724 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9725 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9726 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9727
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009728 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9729 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9730 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009731
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009732 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9733 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9734 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009735
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009736 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009737 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009738 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009739
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009740 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9741 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9742 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009743
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009744 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009745 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9746 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009747
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009748 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9749
9750 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9751
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009752 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9753
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009754 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009755
9756
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009757tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9758 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009760 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009761 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009762 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9763 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009764
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009765 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009766
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009767 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009768 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9769 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9770 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9771 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009772
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009773 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9774 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9775 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9776 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009777 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9778 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9779 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9780 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9781 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9782 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009783 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009784 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009785
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009786 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9787 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9788 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9789 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009790
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009791 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009792 - accept : the request is accepted
9793 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9794 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009795 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009796 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009797 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009798 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009799 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009800 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009801 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009802 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009803 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009804
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009805 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9806 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009807
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009808 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9809 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9810 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9811 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9812 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9813 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009814
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009815 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009816 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9817 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009818
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009819 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009820 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9821 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9822 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9823 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009824 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9825 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9826 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009827
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009828 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009829 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9830 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9831 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009832
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009833 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009834 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9835 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009836
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009837 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9838 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009839 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009840 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9841 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009842 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009843 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009844 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009845 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9846 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009847 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009848 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9849 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009850
9851 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9852 followed by some converters.
9853
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009854 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9855 <var-name>.
9856
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009857 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9858 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9859 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9860 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9861 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9862
9863 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9864 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9865 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9866 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9867 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9868 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9869 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9870 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9871 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9872 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9873 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9874
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009875 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9876 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9877 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9878 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9879 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9880
9881 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9882
9883 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9884
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009885 Example:
9886
9887 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009888 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009889
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009890 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009891 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9892 # and reject everything else.
9893 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9894 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009895 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009896 tcp-request content reject
9897
9898 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009899 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9900 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9901 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009902 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009903
9904 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9905 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9906 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009907 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009908 tcp-request content reject
9909
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009910 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009911 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009912 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009913 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009914 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9915 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009916
9917 Example:
9918 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9919 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009920 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009921
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009922 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009923 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009924
9925 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009926 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009927 # protecting all our sites
9928 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009929 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9930 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009931 ...
9932 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9933
9934 backend http_dynamic
9935 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009936 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009937 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009938 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009939 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009940 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009941 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009942
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009943 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009944
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009945 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9946 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009947
9948
9949tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9950 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009952 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009953 Arguments :
9954 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9955 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9956 as explained at the top of this document.
9957
9958 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9959 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9960 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9961 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9962 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9963
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009964 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9965 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9966 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9967 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9968
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009969 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9970 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009971 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009972 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009973 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9974 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9975 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9976 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009977
9978 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9979 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9980 it pass through unaffected.
9981
9982 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9983 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9984 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009985 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009986 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9987 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009988 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9989 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9990 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009991
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009992 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009993 "timeout client".
9994
9995
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009996tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9997 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9999 no | no | yes | yes
10000 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010001 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10002 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010003
10004 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10005
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010006 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010007 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10008 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010009 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10010 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010011
10012 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10013
10014 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10015 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10016 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10017 inserted.
10018
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010019 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010020 - accept :
10021 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10022 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10023 the rules evaluation.
10024
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010025 - close :
10026 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10027 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10028 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10029 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10030 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10031 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010032 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010033 protocols.
10034
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010035 - reject :
10036 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10037 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010038 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010039
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010040 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10041 Sets a variable.
10042
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010043 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10044 Unsets a variable.
10045
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010046 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10047 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10048 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10049 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10050
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010051 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10052 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10053 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10054 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10055
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010056 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10057 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10058 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10059 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10060 continues.
10061
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010062 - "silent-drop" :
10063 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010064 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010065 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10066 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10067 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10068 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10069 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010070 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10071 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010072 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10073 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010074 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010075 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10076 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10077 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10078 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10079
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010080 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10081 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10082
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010083 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10084 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10085 for changing the default action to a reject.
10086
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010087 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10088 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10089 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10090 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010091 period.
10092
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010093 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10094 declared inline.
10095
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010096 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10097 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010098 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010099 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10100 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010101 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010102 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010103 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010104 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10105 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010106 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010107 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10108 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010109
10110 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10111 followed by some converters.
10112
10113 Example:
10114
10115 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10116
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010117 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10118 <var-name>.
10119
10120 Example:
10121
10122 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10123
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010124 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10125 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10126 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10127 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10128 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10129
10130 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10131
10132 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10133
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010134 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10135
10136 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10137
10138
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010139tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10140 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10142 no | yes | yes | no
10143 Arguments :
10144 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10145 below.
10146
10147 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10148
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010149 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010150 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10151 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10152 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10153 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10154 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10155 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10156 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010157 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010158 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10159 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10160 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10161 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10162 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10163 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10164 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10165 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10166 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10167 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10168 instead.
10169
10170 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10171 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10172 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10173 rules which may be inserted.
10174
10175 Several types of actions are supported :
10176 - accept : the request is accepted
10177 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10178 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10179 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010180 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010181 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10182 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010183 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010184 - silent-drop
10185
10186 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10187 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10188 sections for a complete description.
10189
10190 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10191 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10192 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10193
10194 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10195 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10196 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10197 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10198 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10199
10200 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10201 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10202
10203 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10204 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10205 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10206
10207 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10208 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10209 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10210
10211 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10212 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10213 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10214
10215 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10216 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10217 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10218
10219 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10220
10221 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10222
10223
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010224tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10225 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10227 no | no | yes | yes
10228 Arguments :
10229 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10230 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10231 as explained at the top of this document.
10232
10233 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10234
10235
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010236timeout check <timeout>
10237 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10238 established.
10239
10240 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10241 yes | no | yes | yes
10242 Arguments:
10243 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10244 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10245 as explained at the top of this document.
10246
10247 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10248 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010249 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010250 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010251 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10252 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10253 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010254
10255 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10256 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10257
10258 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10259 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010260 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010261
10262 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10263 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10264 forget about it.
10265
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010266 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10267 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010268
10269
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010270timeout client <timeout>
10271timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10272 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10274 yes | yes | yes | no
10275 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010276 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010277 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10278 as explained at the top of this document.
10279
10280 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10281 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10282 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010283 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10284 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10285 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10286 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010287 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10288 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10289 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010290 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010291 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010292 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10293 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010294 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10295 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010296
10297 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10298 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10299 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10300 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10301 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10302 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10303
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010304 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010305
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010306 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10307 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10308 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10309
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010310 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10311 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010312
10313
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010314timeout client-fin <timeout>
10315 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10317 yes | yes | yes | no
10318 Arguments :
10319 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10320 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10321 as explained at the top of this document.
10322
10323 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10324 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10325 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10326 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10327 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10328 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10329 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010330 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10331 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10332 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010333
10334 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10335 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10336 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10337
10338 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10339
10340
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010341timeout connect <timeout>
10342timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10343 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10345 yes | no | yes | yes
10346 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010347 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010348 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10349 as explained at the top of this document.
10350
10351 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010352 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010353 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010354 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010355 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10356 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010357
10358 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10359 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10360 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10361 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10362 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10363 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10364
10365 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10366 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10367 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10368
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010369 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10370 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010371
10372
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010373timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10374 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10376 yes | yes | yes | yes
10377 Arguments :
10378 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10379 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10380 as explained at the top of this document.
10381
10382 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10383 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10384 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10385 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10386 once the request has started to present itself.
10387
10388 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10389 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10390 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10391 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10392 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10393
10394 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10395 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10396 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10397 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10398
10399 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10400 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010401 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010402 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10403 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010404 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010405
10406 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10407 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10408 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10409 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10410
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010411 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10412 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010413 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10414
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010415 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10416
10417
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010418timeout http-request <timeout>
10419 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010421 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010422 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010423 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010424 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10425 as explained at the top of this document.
10426
10427 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10428 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10429 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10430 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10431 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10432 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10433 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010434 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10435 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10436 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10437 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010438 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010439 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10440 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010441
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010442 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10443 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10444 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10445 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10446 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010447 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010448
10449 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10450 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010451 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010452 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10453 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10454
10455 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010456 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10457 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10458 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010459
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010460 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010461 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010462
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010463
10464timeout queue <timeout>
10465 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10467 yes | no | yes | yes
10468 Arguments :
10469 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10470 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10471 as explained at the top of this document.
10472
10473 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10474 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10475 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10476 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10477 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10478
10479 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10480 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10481 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10482 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10483
10484 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10485
10486
10487timeout server <timeout>
10488timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10489 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10491 yes | no | yes | yes
10492 Arguments :
10493 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10494 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10495 as explained at the top of this document.
10496
10497 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10498 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10499 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10500 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10501 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10502 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10503 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10504
10505 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10506 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10507 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10508 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10509 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010510 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010511 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010512 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10513 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010514 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10515 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010516
10517 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10518 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10519 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10520 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10521 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10522 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10523
10524 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10525 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10526 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10527
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010528 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010529
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010530
10531timeout server-fin <timeout>
10532 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10534 yes | no | yes | yes
10535 Arguments :
10536 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10537 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10538 as explained at the top of this document.
10539
10540 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10541 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10542 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10543 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10544 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10545 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10546 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10547 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10548 situations, it should not be needed.
10549
10550 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10551 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10552 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10553
10554 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10555
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010556
10557timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010558 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10560 yes | yes | yes | yes
10561 Arguments :
10562 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10563 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10564 as explained at the top of this document.
10565
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010566 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10567 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10568 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10569 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010570
10571 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10572 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10573 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10574 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010575 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010576
10577 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10578
10579
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010580timeout tunnel <timeout>
10581 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10583 yes | no | yes | yes
10584 Arguments :
10585 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10586 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10587 as explained at the top of this document.
10588
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010589 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010590 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10591 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10592 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010593 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10594 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010595 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10596 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10597 specified.
10598
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010599 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10600 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10601 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10602 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10603 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10604 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10605 state.
10606
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010607 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10608 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10609 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10610 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010611 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010612
10613 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10614 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10615 forget about it.
10616
10617 Example :
10618 defaults http
10619 option http-server-close
10620 timeout connect 5s
10621 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010622 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010623 timeout server 30s
10624 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10625
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010626 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010627
10628
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010629transparent (deprecated)
10630 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010632 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010633 Arguments : none
10634
10635 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10636 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10637 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10638 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10639 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10640 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10641 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10642 appropriate server.
10643
10644 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10645
10646 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10647 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10648
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010649 See also: "option transparent"
10650
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010651unique-id-format <string>
10652 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10654 yes | yes | yes | no
10655 Arguments :
10656 <string> is a log-format string.
10657
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010658 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10659 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10660 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10661 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010662
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010663 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10664 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10665 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10666 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10667 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10668 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10669 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10670 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010671
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010672 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10673 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010674
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010675 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010676
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010677 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010678
10679 will generate:
10680
10681 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10682
10683 See also: "unique-id-header"
10684
10685unique-id-header <name>
10686 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10688 yes | yes | yes | no
10689 Arguments :
10690 <name> is the name of the header.
10691
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010692 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10693 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010694
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010695 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010696
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010697 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010698 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10699
10700 will generate:
10701
10702 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10703
10704 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010705
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010706use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010707 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10709 no | yes | yes | no
10710 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010711 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10712 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010713
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010714 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10715 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010716
10717 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10718 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10719 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010720 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010721 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010722 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10723 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010724
10725 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10726 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10727 assign the backend.
10728
10729 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10730 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10731 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10732 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10733 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10734 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10735
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010736 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010737 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010738 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10739 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10740 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10741
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010742 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10743 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10744 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10745 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10746 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10747 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10748 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10749 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10750 cannot be forced from the request.
10751
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010752 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010753 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10754 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10755
10756 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10757 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010758
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010759
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010760use-server <server> if <condition>
10761use-server <server> unless <condition>
10762 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10764 no | no | yes | yes
10765 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010766 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010767
10768 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10769
10770 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10771 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10772 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10773
10774 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10775 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10776 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10777 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10778 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10779 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10780 matches will assign the server.
10781
10782 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10783 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10784 with the next rules until one matches.
10785
10786 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10787 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10788 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10789 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10790
10791 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10792 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10793 stripped.
10794
10795 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10796 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10797 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10798 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10799
10800 Example :
10801 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10802 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10803 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10804 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10805 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10806 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010807 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010808 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10809 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10810
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010811 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010812
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010813
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100108145. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010815--------------------------
10816
10817The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10818depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10819settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10820written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10821described in this section.
10822
10823
108245.1. Bind options
10825-----------------
10826
10827The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10828as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10829no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10830parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10831while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10832provided immediately after the setting name.
10833
10834The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10835
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010836accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10837 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10838 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10839 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10840 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10841 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10842 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10843 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10844 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10845 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010846 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10847 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10848 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010849
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010850accept-proxy
10851 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010852 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10853 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010854 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10855 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10856 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10857 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010858 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010859 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10860 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010861 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10862 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010863
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010864allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010865 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010866 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
10867 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
10868 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10869 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010870
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010871alpn <protocols>
10872 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10873 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10874 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10875 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10876 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010877 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10878 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10879 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10880 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10881 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10882 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10883 preference, like below :
10884
10885 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010886
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010887backlog <backlog>
10888 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10889 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10890
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010891curves <curves>
10892 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10893 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10894 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10895 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10896 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10897 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10898
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010899ecdhe <named curve>
10900 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010901 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10902 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010903
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010904ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010905 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10906 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10907 client's certificate.
10908
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010909ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10910 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10911 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10912 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10913 error is ignored.
10914
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010915ca-sign-file <cafile>
10916 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10917 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10918 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10919 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10920 'generate-certificates' for details.
10921
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010922ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010923 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10924 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10925 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10926 'generate-certificates' for details.
10927
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010928ciphers <ciphers>
10929 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10930 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010931 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010932 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010933 information and recommendations see e.g.
10934 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10935 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10936 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10937
10938ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10939 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10940 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10941 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10942 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010943 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10944 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010945
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010946crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010947 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10948 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10949 to verify client's certificate.
10950
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010951crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010952 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10953 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10954 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10955 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10956 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10957 file.
10958
10959 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10960 are loaded.
10961
10962 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010963 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010964 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10965 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10966 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10967 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010968 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10969 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010970 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010971
10972 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10973 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10974 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10975 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010976 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10977 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010978
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010979 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010980
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010981 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010982 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010983 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10984 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010985 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10986 clients).
10987
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010988 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10989 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10990 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10991 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10992 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10993 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10994 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10995 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10996 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10997 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10998 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10999 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11000 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11001
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011002 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11003 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11004 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11005 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11006 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11007
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011008 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11009 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11010 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11011 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011012
11013 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11014 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11015 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11016 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11017 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11018 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11019 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11020 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11021 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11022
11023 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11024
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011025 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011026 a cert bundle.
11027
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011028 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011029 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11030 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11031 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11032 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11033 provide multi-cert support.
11034
11035 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11036
11037 Filename | CN | SAN
11038 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11039 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011040 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011041 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11042 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11043
11044 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11045 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11046 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11047 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011048 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11049 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11050 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011051
11052 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11053 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11054
11055 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11056 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11057 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11058
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011059crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011060 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011061 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011062 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011063 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011064
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011065crt-list <file>
11066 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011067 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11068 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011069
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011070 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11071
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011072 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11073 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011074 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011075 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011076
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011077 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11078 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11079 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11080 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11081 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11082 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11083 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11084 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011085
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011086 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011087 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011088 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11089 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11090 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011091
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011092 crt-list file example:
11093 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011094 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011095 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011096 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011097
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011098defer-accept
11099 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11100 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11101 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011102 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011103 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11104 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11105 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11106 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11107 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11108 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11109 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11110
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011111expose-fd listeners
11112 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11113 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011114 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11115 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011116 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011117
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011118force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011119 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011120 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011121 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011122 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011123
11124force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011125 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011126 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011127 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011128
11129force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011130 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011131 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011132 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011133
11134force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011135 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011136 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011137 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011138
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011139force-tlsv13
11140 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11141 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011142 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011143
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011144generate-certificates
11145 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11146 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11147 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11148 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11149 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11150 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11151 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11152 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11153 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11154 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11155 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11156
11157 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11158 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011159 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011160 certificate is used many times.
11161
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011162gid <gid>
11163 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11164 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11165 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11166 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11167 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11168
11169group <group>
11170 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11171 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11172 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11173 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11174 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11175
11176id <id>
11177 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11178 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11179 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11180 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11181
11182interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011183 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11184 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11185 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11186 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11187 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11188 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011189 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11190 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11191 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11192 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11193 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11194 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011195
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011196level <level>
11197 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11198 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11199 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011200 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011201 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11202 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11203 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011204 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011205 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011206 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011207 all counters).
11208
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011209severity-output <format>
11210 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11211 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11212 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11213 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11214 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11215 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11216 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11217 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11218 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11219 rfc5424 convention.
11220
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011221maxconn <maxconn>
11222 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11223 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11224 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11225 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11226 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11227 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11228 eat all memory.
11229
11230mode <mode>
11231 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11232 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11233 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11234 UNIX sockets.
11235
11236mss <maxseg>
11237 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11238 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11239 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11240 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11241 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11242 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11243 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11244 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11245 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11246 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11247 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11248
11249name <name>
11250 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11251 page.
11252
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011253namespace <name>
11254 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11255 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11256 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11257 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11258
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011259nice <nice>
11260 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11261 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11262 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11263 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11264 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11265 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11266 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11267 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11268 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11269 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11270 one for an RDP socket.
11271
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011272no-ca-names
11273 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11274 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11275
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011276no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011277 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011278 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011279 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011280 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011281 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11282 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011283
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011284no-tls-tickets
11285 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11286 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11287 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011288 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11289 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011290
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011291no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011292 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011293 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011294 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011295 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011296 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11297 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011298
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011299no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011300 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011301 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011302 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011303 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011304 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11305 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011306
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011307no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011308 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011309 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011310 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011311 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011312 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11313 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011314
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011315no-tlsv13
11316 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11317 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11318 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11319 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011320 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11321 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011322
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011323npn <protocols>
11324 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11325 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11326 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11327 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011328 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011329 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11330 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11331 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11332 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11333 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011334
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011335prefer-client-ciphers
11336 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11337 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11338 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011339 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11340 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11341 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011342
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011343process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011344 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011345 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011346 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011347 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11348 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11349 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11350 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011351 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011352 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11353 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11354 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11355 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11356 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011357
11358 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11359
11360 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11361 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11362 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11363 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11364 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11365 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11366 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11367 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011368
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011369proto <name>
11370 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11371 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11372 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11373 in haproxy -vv.
11374 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11375 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011376 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011377 h2" on the bind line.
11378
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011379ssl
11380 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011381 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011382 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11383 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011384 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11385 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011386
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011387ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11388 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11389 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11390 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11391
11392ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11393 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11394 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11395 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11396
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011397strict-sni
11398 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11399 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11400 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11401 See the "crt" option for more information.
11402
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011403tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011404 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011405 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11406 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011407 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011408 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11409 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11410 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11411 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11412 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11413 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11414 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11415
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011416tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011417 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011418 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11419 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11420 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11421 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11422 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11423 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11424 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011425 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11426 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11427 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011428
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011429tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11430 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011431 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11432 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11433 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11434 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11435 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11436 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11437 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11438 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11439 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11440 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011441 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11442 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11443
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011444transparent
11445 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11446 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11447 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11448 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11449 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11450 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11451 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11452 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11453 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11454 so check for support with your vendor.
11455
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011456v4v6
11457 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11458 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11459 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11460 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011461 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011462
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011463v6only
11464 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11465 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11466 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011467 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11468 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011469
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011470uid <uid>
11471 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11472 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11473 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11474 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11475 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11476
11477user <user>
11478 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11479 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11480 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11481 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11482 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11483
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011484verify [none|optional|required]
11485 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11486 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11487 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11488 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11489 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011490 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11491 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11492 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11493 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011494
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200114955.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011496------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011497
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011498The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11499which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11500arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11501settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11502after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11503Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11504address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011505
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011506 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011507 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011508
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011509Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11510keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11511
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011512The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011513
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011514addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011515 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011516 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11517 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11518 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11519 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11520 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011521
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011522agent-check
11523 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011524 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011525 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11526 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11527 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011528
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011529 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011530 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011531 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11532 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11533 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011534
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011535 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11536 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11537 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11538 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11539 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011540
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011541 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011542 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011543
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011544 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11545 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11546 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011547
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011548 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11549 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11550 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011551
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011552 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11553 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11554 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11555 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11556 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011557 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011558 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011559
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011560 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11561 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011562
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011563 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11564 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11565 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11566 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11567 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11568 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11569 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11570 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11571 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011572
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011573 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11574 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011575 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11576 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11577 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011578 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011579
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011580 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011581 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011582
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011583agent-send <string>
11584 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11585 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11586 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11587 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11588 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11589
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011590agent-inter <delay>
11591 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11592 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11593
11594 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11595 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11596 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11597 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11598 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11599 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11600 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11601 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11602 of backends use the same servers.
11603
11604 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11605
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011606agent-addr <addr>
11607 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11608
11609 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11610 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11611 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11612 hostname, it will be resolved.
11613
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011614agent-port <port>
11615 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11616
11617 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11618
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011619alpn <protocols>
11620 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11621 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11622 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11623 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11624 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11625 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11626 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11627 now obsolete NPN extension.
11628 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11629 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11630
11631 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11632
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011633backup
11634 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11635 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11636 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11637 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011638 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11639 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011640
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011641ca-file <cafile>
11642 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11643 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11644 server's certificate.
11645
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011646check
11647 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011648 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11649 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11650 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11651 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11652 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11653 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11654 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011655 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11656 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011657 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11658 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011659
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011660check-send-proxy
11661 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11662 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11663 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11664 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11665 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11666 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11667 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11668
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011669check-alpn <protocols>
11670 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11671 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11672 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11673
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011674check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011675 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011676 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11677 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011678
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011679check-ssl
11680 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11681 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11682 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11683 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011684 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011685 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11686 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011687 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011688 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11689 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011690
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011691ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011692 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11693 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11694 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011695 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11696 information and recommendations see e.g.
11697 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11698 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11699 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011700
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011701ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11702 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11703 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11704 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11705 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011706 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11707 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11708 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011709
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011710cookie <value>
11711 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11712 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11713 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11714 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11715 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11716 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11717 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11718
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011719crl-file <crlfile>
11720 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11721 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11722 to verify server's certificate.
11723
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011724crt <cert>
11725 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11726 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11727 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11728 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11729 certificate request.
11730
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011731disabled
11732 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11733 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11734 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11735 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11736 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011737 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011738
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011739enabled
11740 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11741 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11742 default value.
11743 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11744 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011746error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011747 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11748 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11749 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011750
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011751 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011752
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011753fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011754 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11755 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11756 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11757
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011758force-sslv3
11759 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11760 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011761 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011762 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011763
11764force-tlsv10
11765 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011766 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011767 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011768
11769force-tlsv11
11770 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011771 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011772 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011773
11774force-tlsv12
11775 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011776 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011777 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011778
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011779force-tlsv13
11780 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11781 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011782 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011783
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011784id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011785 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11786 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11787 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011788
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011789init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11790 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11791 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011792 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011793 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11794 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11795 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11796 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11797 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11798 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11799 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11800 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11801 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011802 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011803 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11804 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11805 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11806 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11807 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11808 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011809 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011810
11811 Example:
11812 defaults
11813 # never fail on address resolution
11814 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11815
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011816inter <delay>
11817fastinter <delay>
11818downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011819 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11820 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11821 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11822 between checks depending on the server state :
11823
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011824 Server state | Interval used
11825 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11826 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11827 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11828 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11829 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11830 or yet unchecked. |
11831 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11832 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11833 | "inter" otherwise.
11834 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011835
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011836 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11837 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11838 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11839 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011840 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11841 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11842 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11843 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11844 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011845
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011846maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011847 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11848 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11849 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11850 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11851 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11852 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11853 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11854 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11855
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011856maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011857 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11858 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11859 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11860 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11861 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11862 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11863 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11864
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011865max-reuse <count>
11866 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11867 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11868 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11869 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11870 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11871 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11872 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11873 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11874
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011875minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011876 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11877 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11878 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11879 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11880 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11881 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011882 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011883 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011884
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011885namespace <name>
11886 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11887 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11888 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11889 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11890
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011891no-agent-check
11892 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11893 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11894 default value.
11895 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11896 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11897
11898no-backup
11899 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11900 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11901 default value.
11902 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11903 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11904
11905no-check
11906 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11907 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11908 default value.
11909 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11910 "default-server" "check" setting.
11911
11912no-check-ssl
11913 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11914 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11915 default value.
11916 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11917 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11918
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011919no-send-proxy
11920 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11921 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11922 default value.
11923 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11924 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11925
11926no-send-proxy-v2
11927 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11928 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11929 default value.
11930 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11931 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11932
11933no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11934 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11935 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11936 default value.
11937 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11938 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11939
11940no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11941 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11942 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11943 default value.
11944 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11945 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11946
11947no-ssl
11948 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11949 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11950 default value.
11951 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11952 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11953
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011954no-ssl-reuse
11955 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11956 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11957 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11958 and for paranoid users.
11959
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011960no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011961 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11962 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011963 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011964
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011965 Supported in default-server: No
11966
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011967no-tls-tickets
11968 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11969 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11970 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011971 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11972 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011973 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011974
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011975no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011976 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011977 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11978 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011979 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11980 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011981 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011982
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011983 Supported in default-server: No
11984
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011985no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011986 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011987 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11988 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011989 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11990 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011991 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011992
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011993 Supported in default-server: No
11994
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011995no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011996 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011997 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11998 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011999 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12000 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012001 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012002
12003 Supported in default-server: No
12004
12005no-tlsv13
12006 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12007 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12008 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12009 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12010 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012011 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012012
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012013 Supported in default-server: No
12014
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012015no-verifyhost
12016 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12017 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12018 default value.
12019 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12020 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012021
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012022non-stick
12023 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12024 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12025 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12026
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012027npn <protocols>
12028 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12029 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12030 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12031 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12032 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12033 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12034 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12035
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012036observe <mode>
12037 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12038 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12039 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12040 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12041 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12042 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012043 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012044
12045 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012047on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012048 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12049 Currently, four modes are available:
12050 - fastinter: force fastinter
12051 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12052 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12053 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12054 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12055
12056 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12057
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012058on-marked-down <action>
12059 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12060 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012061 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12062 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12063 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12064 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12065 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12066 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12067 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12068 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012069
12070 Actions are disabled by default
12071
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012072on-marked-up <action>
12073 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12074 Currently one action is available:
12075 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12076 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12077 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12078 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012079 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12080 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012081 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12082 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12083
12084 Actions are disabled by default
12085
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012086pool-max-conn <max>
12087 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12088 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12089 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12090 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12091 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12092 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12093
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012094pool-purge-delay <delay>
12095 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
12096 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means it's never purged. The default is
12097 1s.
12098
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012099port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012100 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12101 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12102 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12103 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12104 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12105 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12106
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012107proto <name>
12108
12109 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12110 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12111 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12112 reported in haproxy -vv.
12113 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12114 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12115
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012116redir <prefix>
12117 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12118 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12119 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12120 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12121 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12122 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12123 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12124 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012125 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012126 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012127 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12128 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12129 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12130 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12131
12132 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12133
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012134rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012135 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12136 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12137 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12138
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012139resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12140 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12141 server.
12142
12143 Available options:
12144
12145 * allow-dup-ip
12146 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12147 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12148 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12149 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12150 For such case, simply enable this option.
12151 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12152
12153 * prevent-dup-ip
12154 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12155 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12156 same fqdn.
12157 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12158
12159 Example:
12160 backend b_myapp
12161 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12162 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12163 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12164
12165 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12166 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12167 it
12168 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12169 different address
12170
12171 Default value: not set
12172
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012173resolve-prefer <family>
12174 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12175 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12176 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12177 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12178
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012179 Default value: ipv6
12180
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012181 Example:
12182
12183 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012184
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012185resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12186 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12187 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012188 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012189 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12190 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012191 configured network, another address is selected.
12192
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012193 Example:
12194
12195 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012196
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012197resolvers <id>
12198 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12199 hostname.
12200
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012201 Example:
12202
12203 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012204
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012205 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012206
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012207send-proxy
12208 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12209 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12210 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12211 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012212 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12213 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12214 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12215 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12216 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12217 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12218 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12219 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12220 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12221 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012222 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12223 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012224
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012225send-proxy-v2
12226 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12227 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12228 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12229 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012230 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12231 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12232 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12233 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012234
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012235proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12236 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12237 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012238 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12239 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012240 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12241 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012242 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012243
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012244send-proxy-v2-ssl
12245 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12246 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12247 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12248 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12249 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12250 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12251 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012252 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12253 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012254
12255send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12256 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12257 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12258 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12259 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12260 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12261 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12262 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12263 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012264 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12265 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012266
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012267slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012268 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12269 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12270 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12271 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12272 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12273 parameters :
12274
12275 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12276 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12277
12278 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12279 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12280 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12281 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12282
12283 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12284 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12285 seen as failed.
12286
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012287sni <expression>
12288 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12289 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12290 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12291 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012292 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12293 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012294 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012295 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12296 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012297
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012298source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012299source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012300source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012301 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12302 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12303 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12304 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12305
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012306 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12307 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12308 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12309 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12310 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12311 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12312 server.
12313
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012314 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12315 specifying the source address without port(s).
12316
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012317ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012318 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12319 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12320 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12321 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12322 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12323 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012324 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12325 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012326
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012327ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12328 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12329 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12330 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12331
12332ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12333 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12334 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12335 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12336
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012337ssl-reuse
12338 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12339 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12340 default value.
12341 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12342 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12343
12344stick
12345 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12346 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12347 default value.
12348 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12349 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012350
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012351tcp-ut <delay>
12352 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12353 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12354 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012355 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012356 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12357 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12358 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12359 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12360 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12361 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12362 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12363 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12364 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012366track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012367 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12368 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12369 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12370 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012371 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12372
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012373tls-tickets
12374 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12375 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12376 default value.
12377 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12378 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012379
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012380verify [none|required]
12381 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012382 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012383 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12384 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012385 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012386 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12387 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12388 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12389 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12390 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12391 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12392 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12393 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012394
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012395verifyhost <hostname>
12396 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012397 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12398 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12399 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12400 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12401 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12402 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12403 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12404 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012405
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012406weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012407 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12408 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12409 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012410 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12411 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12412 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12413 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12414 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12415 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012416
12417
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124185.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12419-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012420
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012421HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12422using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12423configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012424This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12425can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12426workload.
12427This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12428resolution at run time.
12429Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12430carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12431
12432
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124335.3.1. Global overview
12434----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012435
12436As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12437different steps of the process life:
12438
12439 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12440 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12441 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12442
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012443 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12444 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012445
12446A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12447 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12448 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12449 resolution to know this new IP.
12450
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012451When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012452HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012453SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12454from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12455will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12456will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012457
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012458A few things important to notice:
12459 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12460 first valid response.
12461
12462 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12463 servers return an error.
12464
12465
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124665.3.2. The resolvers section
12467----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012468
12469This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012470HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12471contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012472
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012473When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12474uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12475is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12476answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12477
12478When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012479used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012480
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012481 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12482 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12483 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012484
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012485 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12486 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012487
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012488 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12489 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12490 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012491
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012492For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12493following scenarios are possible:
12494
12495 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12496 ignored
12497
12498 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12499 applied
12500
12501 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12502 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12503
12504 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12505 retries the query with a new type
12506
12507 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12508 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012509
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012510As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12511a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012512<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012513
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012514
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012515resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012516 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012517
12518A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12519
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012520accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012521 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012522 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012523 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12524 by RFC 6891)
12525
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012526 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12527
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012528nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12529 DNS server description:
12530 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12531 <ip> : IP address of the server
12532 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12533
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012534parse-resolv-conf
12535 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12536 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12537 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12538
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012539hold <status> <period>
12540 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12541 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012542 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012543 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012544 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12545 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12546 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12547
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012548 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012549
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012550resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012551 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12552 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12553 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12554
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012555resolve_retries <nb>
12556 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12557 giving up.
12558 Default value: 3
12559
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012560 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12561 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12562 type.
12563
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012564timeout <event> <time>
12565 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12566 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12567 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012568 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12569 other time applied.
12570 Default value: 1s
12571 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
12572 have been received.
12573 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012574 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12575 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12576
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012577 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012578
12579 resolvers mydns
12580 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12581 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012582 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012583 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012584 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012585 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012586 hold other 30s
12587 hold refused 30s
12588 hold nx 30s
12589 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012590 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012591 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012592
12593
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125946. HTTP header manipulation
12595---------------------------
12596
12597In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12598response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12599request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12600which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012601against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012602
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012603If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12604to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12605but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12606HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12607stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12608because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12609a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12610still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012611
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012612This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12613in section 4.2 :
12614
12615 - reqadd <string>
12616 - reqallow <search>
12617 - reqiallow <search>
12618 - reqdel <search>
12619 - reqidel <search>
12620 - reqdeny <search>
12621 - reqideny <search>
12622 - reqpass <search>
12623 - reqipass <search>
12624 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12625 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12626 - reqtarpit <search>
12627 - reqitarpit <search>
12628 - rspadd <string>
12629 - rspdel <search>
12630 - rspidel <search>
12631 - rspdeny <search>
12632 - rspideny <search>
12633 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12634 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12635
12636With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12637is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12638parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12639prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12640Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12641
12642 \t for a tab
12643 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12644 \n for a new line (LF)
12645 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12646 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12647 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12648 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12649 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12650
12651The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12652portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12653above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12654regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
126559 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12656is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12657
12658The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12659after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12660
12661Notes related to these keywords :
12662---------------------------------
12663 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12664 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12665 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12666
12667 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12668 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12669 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12670
12671 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12672 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12673 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12674 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12675 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12676
12677 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12678 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12679 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12680 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12681 useless headers before adding new ones.
12682
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012683 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012684 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12685
12686 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12687 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12688 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12689
12690 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12691 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012692 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012693
12694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126957. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12696----------------------------------
12697
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012698HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012699client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12700The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12701these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12702but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12703data called patterns.
12704
12705
127067.1. ACL basics
12707---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012708
12709The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12710content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12711from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12712simple :
12713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012714 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012715 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012716 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12717 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012719The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12720adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012721
12722In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012724 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012725
12726This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12727Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12728and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012729an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12730conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12731as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12732are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012733
12734ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12735'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12736which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12737
12738There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12739performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012741The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12742specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12743this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012744methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12745ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012746
12747Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12748 - boolean
12749 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12750 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12751 - string
12752 - data block
12753
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012754Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12755converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12756would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12757The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12758which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12759
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012760Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12761keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12762fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12763which are summarized in the table below :
12764
12765 +---------------------+-----------------+
12766 | Sample or converter | Default |
12767 | output type | matching method |
12768 +---------------------+-----------------+
12769 | boolean | bool |
12770 +---------------------+-----------------+
12771 | integer | int |
12772 +---------------------+-----------------+
12773 | ip | ip |
12774 +---------------------+-----------------+
12775 | string | str |
12776 +---------------------+-----------------+
12777 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12778 +---------------------+-----------------+
12779
12780Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12781matching method, see below.
12782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012783The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12784 - boolean
12785 - integer or integer range
12786 - IP address / network
12787 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12788 - regular expression
12789 - hex block
12790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012791The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12792
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012793 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12794 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012795 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012796 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012797 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012798 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012799 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012801The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12802read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12803if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12804lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12805will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12806beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12807a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12808lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12809exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12810
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012811The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12812parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12813ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12814a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12815check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12816
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012817The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12818socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12819file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012821Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12822loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12823
12824 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12825
12826In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12827the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12828case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12829as well.
12830
12831The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12832sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12833do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12834methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12835is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012836obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012837followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12838default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12839that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12840string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12841
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012842The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12843By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12844string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12845resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12846server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12847waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12848flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12849function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012851There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12852sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12853be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012854
12855 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12856 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012857 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12858 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12859 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12860 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012861
12862 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12863 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012864 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012865
12866 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012867 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012868
12869 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012870 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012871
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012872 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012873 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12874
12875 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12876 binary or string samples.
12877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012878 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12879 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012881 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12882 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12883 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012885 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12886 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012888 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12889 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012891 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12892 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012894 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12895 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012896 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012898 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12899 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12900 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012901
12902For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12903request, it is possible to do :
12904
12905 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12906
12907In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12908buffer, one would use the following acl :
12909
12910 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12911
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012912On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12913possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12914
12915 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012917All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12918criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12919method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12920to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12921criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12922the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012924If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012925the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12926For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012928 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12929 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12930 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12931 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012932
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012933
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012934The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12935types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12936combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12937brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12938default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012940 +-------------------------------------------------+
12941 | Input sample type |
12942 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012943 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012944 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12945 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12946 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012947 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012948 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012949 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012950 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012951 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012952 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012953 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012954 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012955 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012956 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012957 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012958 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012959 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012960 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012961 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012962 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012963 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012964 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012965 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012966 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012967 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012968 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12969 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12970 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012971
12972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129737.1.1. Matching booleans
12974------------------------
12975
12976In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12977Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12978When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12979that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12980
12981Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12982return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12983"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12984
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129867.1.2. Matching integers
12987------------------------
12988
12989Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12990enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12991to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12992
12993Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12994matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12995lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012996
12997For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12998unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12999representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13000
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013001As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13002two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13003instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13004ranges and operators.
13005
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013006For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013007operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13008Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13009of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013010
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013011Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013012
13013 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13014 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13015 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13016 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13017 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13018
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013019For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013020
13021 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13022
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013023This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13024
13025 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13026
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130287.1.3. Matching strings
13029-----------------------
13030
13031String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13032different forms :
13033
13034 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013035 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013036
13037 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013038 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013039
13040 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13041 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13042
13043 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13044 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13045
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013046 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013047 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13048 matches.
13049
13050 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13051 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13052 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013053
13054String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13055exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13056characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13057string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13058to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013059before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013060
13061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130627.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13063---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013064
13065Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13066they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13067possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13068passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13069the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013070the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13071match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013072
13073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13075-------------------------------------
13076
13077It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13078not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13079a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13080to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13081digits may be used upper or lower case.
13082
13083Example :
13084 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13085 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13086
13087
130887.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13089---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013090
13091IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13092netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13093within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013094host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013095difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13096at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13097does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13098parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013099
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013100The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13101abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13102
13103 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13104 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13105 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13106 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13107 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13108 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13109 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13110 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13111
13112Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13113192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13114
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013115IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13116Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13117trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13118IPv6 patterns.
13119
13120HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13121following situations :
13122 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13123 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13124 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13125 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13126 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13127 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13128 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13129 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13130 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13131 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013133
131347.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13135----------------------------------
13136
13137Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13138combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13139
13140 - AND (implicit)
13141 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13142 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013144A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013146 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013148Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13149indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013151For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13152"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13153requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13154is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13155
13156 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013157 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13158 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13159 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013160
13161To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13162and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13163
13164 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13165 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13166 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13167 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13168
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013169 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013170 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13171 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13172 use_backend www if host_www
13173
13174It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13175expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13176be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13177the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13178
13179 The following rule :
13180
13181 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013182 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013183
13184 Can also be written that way :
13185
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013186 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013187
13188It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13189to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13190simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13191sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13192good use is the following :
13193
13194 With named ACLs :
13195
13196 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13197 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13198 monitor fail if site_dead
13199
13200 With anonymous ACLs :
13201
13202 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13203
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013204See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13205keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013206
13207
132087.3. Fetching samples
13209---------------------
13210
13211Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13212against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13213sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13214ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13215of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13216available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13217
13218This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13219Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13220compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13221deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13222
13223The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13224matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13225method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13226indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13227
13228As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13229when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13230mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13231the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13232ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13233
13234Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13235multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13236when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013237incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13238are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013239is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13240all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13241
13242Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13243 - name
13244 - name(arg1)
13245 - name(arg1,arg2)
13246
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013247
132487.3.1. Converters
13249-----------------
13250
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013251Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13252of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13253is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13254was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013255has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013256unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13257
13258These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13259sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13260the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013261support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013262
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013263A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13264support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13265supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13266(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13267bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013269The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013270
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001327151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13272 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13273 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13274 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13275 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13276 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13277
13278 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013279 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13280 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013281 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13282 frontend http-in
13283 bind *:8081
13284 default_backend servers
13285 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13286 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13287
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013288add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013289 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013290 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013291 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13292 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013293 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013294 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13295 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13296 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13297 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013298 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013299 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013300
13301and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013302 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013303 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013304 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13305 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013306 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013307 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13308 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13309 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13310 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013311 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013312 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013313
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013314b64dec
13315 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13316 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13317
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013318base64
13319 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013320 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013321 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13322
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013323bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013324 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013325 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013326 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013327 presence of a flag).
13328
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013329bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13330 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13331 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013332 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013333
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013334concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13335 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13336 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13337 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13338 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13339 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13340 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13341 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13342 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13343 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13344 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13345 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13346 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13347 delimitors.
13348
13349 Example:
13350 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13351 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13352 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13353 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13354
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013355cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013356 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13357 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013358
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013359crc32([<avalanche>])
13360 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13361 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13362 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13363 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13364 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13365 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13366 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13367 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13368 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13369 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013370 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13371
13372crc32c([<avalanche>])
13373 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13374 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13375 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13376 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13377 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13378 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13379 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13380 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013381
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013382da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013383 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13384 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13385 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13386 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013387 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013388 configuration language.
13389
13390 Example:
13391 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013392 bind *:8881
13393 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013394 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013395
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013396debug
13397 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13398 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13399 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13400
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013401div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013402 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13403 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013404 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013405 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13406 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013407 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013408 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13409 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13410 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13411 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013412 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013413 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013414
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013415djb2([<avalanche>])
13416 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13417 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13418 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13419 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13420 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13421 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13422 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013423 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13424 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013425
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013426even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013427 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013428 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13429
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013430field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13431 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13432 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13433 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13434 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13435 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13436 fields.
13437
13438 Example :
13439 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13440 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13441 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13442 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13443 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013444
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013445hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013446 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013447 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013448 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013449 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013450
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013451hex2i
13452 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13453 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13454
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013455http_date([<offset>])
13456 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13457 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13458 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13459 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13460 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13461 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013462
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013463in_table(<table>)
13464 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13465 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13466 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013467 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013468 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13469
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013470ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13471 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013472 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013473 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13474 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13475 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13476 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13477 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013478
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013479json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013480 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013481 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013482 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013483 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13484 of errors:
13485 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13486 bytes, ...)
13487 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13488 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13489
13490 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13491 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13492 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13493 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13494 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13495 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013496 - "ascii" : never fails;
13497 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13498 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013499 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013500 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013501 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13502 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13503
13504 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013505 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013506
13507 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013508 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013509 capture request header user-agent len 150
13510 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013511
13512 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13513 GET / HTTP/1.0
13514 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13515
13516 Output log:
13517 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13518
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013519language(<value>[,<default>])
13520 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13521 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13522 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13523 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13524 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13525 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13526 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13527 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13528 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013529 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013530 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13531 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013532
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013533 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013534
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013535 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13536 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013537
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013538 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13539 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13540 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13541 use_backend spanish if es
13542 use_backend french if fr
13543 use_backend english if en
13544 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013545
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013546length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013547 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13548 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13549 type. The result is of type integer.
13550
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013551lower
13552 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13553 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13554 type. The result is of type string.
13555
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013556ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13557 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13558 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13559 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13560 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13561 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13562 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13563
13564 Example :
13565
13566 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013567 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013568 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13569
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013570map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13571map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13572map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13573 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13574 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13575 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13576 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13577 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13578 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13579 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13580 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013581
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013582 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13583 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13584 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013585
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013586 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013587 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013588
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013589 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13590 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13591 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13592 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013593 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13594 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013595 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13596 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13597 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13598 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13599 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13600 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13601 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13602 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013603 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13604 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13605 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013606 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13607 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13608 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13609 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13610 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013611
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013612 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13613 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13614 the corresponding match text.
13615
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013616 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13617 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13618 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13619 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13620 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013621
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013622 Example :
13623
13624 # this is a comment and is ignored
13625 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13626 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13627 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13628 | | | `---------- value
13629 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13630 | `---------------------------- key
13631 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13632
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013633mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013634 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13635 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013636 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013637 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013638 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013639 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13640 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13641 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13642 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013643 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013644 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013645
13646mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013647 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013648 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13649 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013650 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013651 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013652 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013653 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13654 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13655 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13656 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013657 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013658 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013659
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013660nbsrv
13661 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13662 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13663 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13664 map lookup.
13665
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013666neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013667 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13668 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13669 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13670 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013671
13672not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013673 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013674 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013675 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013676 absence of a flag).
13677
13678odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013679 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013680 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13681
13682or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013683 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013684 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013685 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13686 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013687 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013688 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13689 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13690 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13691 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013692 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013693 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013694
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013695regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013696 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13697 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13698 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13699 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13700 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13701 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13702 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13703 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13704 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13705 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013706 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13707 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13708 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13709 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013710
13711 Example :
13712
13713 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13714 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13715 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13716 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13717
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013718capture-req(<id>)
13719 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13720 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13721
13722 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013723 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13724 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013725
13726capture-res(<id>)
13727 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13728 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13729
13730 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013731 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13732 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013733
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013734sdbm([<avalanche>])
13735 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13736 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13737 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13738 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13739 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13740 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13741 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013742 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13743 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013744
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013745set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013746 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13747 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13748 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013749 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013750 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13751 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013752 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013753 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13754 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013755 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013756 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013757
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013758sha1
13759 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13760 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13761
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013762strcmp(<var>)
13763 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13764 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13765 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13766 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13767 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13768 shorter).
13769
13770 Example :
13771
13772 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13773 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13774 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13775
13776
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013777sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013778 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13779 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013780 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013781 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13782 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013783 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013784 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13785 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013786 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013787 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13788 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013789 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013790 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013791
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010013792svarint
13793 Converts a binary input sample of a protocol buffers signed "varints" ("sint32"
13794 and "sint64") to an integer.
13795 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message types:
13796 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13797
13798varint
13799 Converts a binary input sample of a protocol buffers "varints", excepted
13800 the signed ones "sint32" and "sint64", to an integer.
13801 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message types:
13802 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13803
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013804table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13805 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13806 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13807 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13808 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13809 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13810 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13811
13812
13813table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13814 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13815 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13816 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13817 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13818 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13819 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13820
13821table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13822 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13823 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013824 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013825 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13826 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13827
13828table_conn_cur(<table>)
13829 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13830 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13831 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13832 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13833 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13834
13835table_conn_rate(<table>)
13836 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13837 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13838 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13839 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13840 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13841
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013842table_gpt0(<table>)
13843 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13844 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13845 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13846 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13847 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13848
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013849table_gpc0(<table>)
13850 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13851 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13852 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13853 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13854 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13855
13856table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13857 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13858 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13859 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13860 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13861 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13862 sample fetch keyword.
13863
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013864table_gpc1(<table>)
13865 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13866 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13867 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13868 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13869 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13870
13871table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13872 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13873 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13874 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13875 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13876 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13877 sample fetch keyword.
13878
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013879table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13880 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13881 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013882 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013883 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13884 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13885
13886table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13887 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13888 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13889 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13890 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13891 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13892 keyword.
13893
13894table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13895 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13896 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013897 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013898 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13899 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13900
13901table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13902 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13903 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13904 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13905 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13906 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13907 keyword.
13908
13909table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13910 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13911 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013912 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013913 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13914 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13915 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13916 keyword.
13917
13918table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13919 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13920 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013921 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013922 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13923 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13924 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13925 keyword.
13926
13927table_server_id(<table>)
13928 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13929 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13930 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13931 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13932 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13933 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13934
13935table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13936 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13937 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013938 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013939 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13940 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13941 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13942 keyword.
13943
13944table_sess_rate(<table>)
13945 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13946 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13947 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13948 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13949 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13950 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13951 keyword.
13952
13953table_trackers(<table>)
13954 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13955 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13956 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13957 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13958 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13959 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13960 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13961 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13962 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13963 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13964
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013965upper
13966 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13967 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13968 type. The result is of type string.
13969
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013970url_dec
13971 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13972 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13973
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013974unset-var(<var name>)
13975 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13976 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13977 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13978 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13979 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13980 response),
13981 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13982 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13983 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13984 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13985
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013986utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13987 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13988 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13989 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13990 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13991 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13992 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13993
13994 Example :
13995
13996 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013997 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013998 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13999
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014000word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14001 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14002 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14003 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14004 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14005 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14006
14007 Example :
14008 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14009 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14010 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14011 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14012 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014013
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014014wt6([<avalanche>])
14015 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14016 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14017 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14018 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14019 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14020 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14021 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014022 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14023 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014024
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014025xor(<value>)
14026 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014027 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014028 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014029 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014030 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014031 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14032 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014033 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014034 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14035 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014036 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014037 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014038
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014039xxh32([<seed>])
14040 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14041 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14042 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14043 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14044 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14045 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14046 as cryptographically secure.
14047
14048xxh64([<seed>])
14049 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14050 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14051 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14052 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14053 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14054 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14055 as cryptographically secure.
14056
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014057
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140587.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014059--------------------------------------------
14060
14061A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14062not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14063"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14064The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14065
14066always_false : boolean
14067 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14068 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14069
14070always_true : boolean
14071 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14072 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14073
14074avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014075 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014076 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14077 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14078 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14079 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14080 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14081 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14082 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14083 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14084 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14085 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14086 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14087 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14088 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014090be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014091 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14092 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14093 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14094 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014095 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14096
14097be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14098 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14099 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14100 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14101 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14102 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014103 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14104 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014105
14106 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14107 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14108 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014110be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14111 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14112 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14113 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014114 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014115 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14116 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014117
14118 Example :
14119 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14120 backend dynamic
14121 mode http
14122 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14123 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014124
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014125bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014126 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14127 of the string.
14128
14129bool(<bool>) : bool
14130 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14131 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014133connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14134 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014135 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014136 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14137 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014138
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014139 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014140 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014141 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14142
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014143 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14144 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014145
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014146 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014147 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014148 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014149 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014150 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014151 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014152 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014153
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014154 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14155 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014156 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014157 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014158
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014159cpu_calls : integer
14160 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14161 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14162 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14163 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14164 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14165 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14166
14167cpu_ns_avg : integer
14168 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14169 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14170 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14171 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14172 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14173 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14174 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14175 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14176 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14177 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14178 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14179
14180cpu_ns_tot : integer
14181 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14182 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14183 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14184 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14185 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14186 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14187 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14188 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14189 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14190 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14191 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14192 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14193 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14194
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014195date([<offset>]) : integer
14196 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14197 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14198 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14199 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014200 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14201
14202 Example :
14203
14204 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14205 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014206
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014207date_us : integer
14208 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14209 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14210 from the same timeval structure.
14211
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014212distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14213 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14214 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14215 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14216 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14217 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14218 list of supported tokens.
14219
14220distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14221 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14222 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14223 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14224 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14225 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14226 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14227 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14228 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14229 supported tokens.
14230
14231 Example :
14232 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14233 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14234 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14235 # send large files to the big farm
14236 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14237
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014238env(<name>) : string
14239 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14240 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14241 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14242 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14243 certain way.
14244
14245 Examples :
14246 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14247 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14248
14249 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14250 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014252fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14253 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014254 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14255 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014256 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14257 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014258 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014259 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14260 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014261
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014262fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14263 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14264 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14265 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014267fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14268 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14269 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14270 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14271 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14272 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14273 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14274 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14275 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014276
14277 Example :
14278 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14279 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14280 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14281 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14282 frontend mail
14283 bind :25
14284 mode tcp
14285 maxconn 100
14286 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14287 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14288 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14289 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014290
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014291hostname : string
14292 Returns the system hostname.
14293
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014294int(<integer>) : signed integer
14295 Returns a signed integer.
14296
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014297ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14298 Returns an ipv4.
14299
14300ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14301 Returns an ipv6.
14302
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014303lat_ns_avg : integer
14304 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14305 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14306 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14307 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14308 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14309 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14310 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14311 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14312 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14313 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14314 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14315 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14316 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14317 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14318
14319lat_ns_tot : integer
14320 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14321 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14322 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14323 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14324 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14325 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14326 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14327 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14328 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14329 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14330 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14331 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14332 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14333 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14334 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14335 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14336 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14337 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14338 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14339
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014340meth(<method>) : method
14341 Returns a method.
14342
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014343nbproc : integer
14344 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14345 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14346 and debugging purposes.
14347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014348nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14349 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14350 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14351 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014352 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14353 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14354 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014355
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014356prio_class : integer
14357 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14358 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14359 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14360
14361prio_offset : integer
14362 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14363 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14364 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14365 set-priority-offset".
14366
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014367proc : integer
14368 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14369 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14370 debugging purposes.
14371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014372queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014373 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14374 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14375 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014376 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14377 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14378 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14379 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14380 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14381
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014382rand([<range>]) : integer
14383 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14384 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14385 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14386 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14387 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014389srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14390 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14391 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14392 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14393 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14394 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014395 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14396 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14397
14398srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14399 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14400 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14401 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14402 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14403 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14404 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14405 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14406
14407 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14408 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014409
14410srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14411 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14412 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14413 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014414 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014415 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14416 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14417 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14418
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014419srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14420 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14421 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14422 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14423 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14424 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14425 fetch methods.
14426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014427srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14428 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14429 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014430 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014431 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14432 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014433 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014434 overloading servers).
14435
14436 Example :
14437 # Redirect to a separate back
14438 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14439 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14440 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14441
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014442stopping : boolean
14443 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14444 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14445 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14446
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014447str(<string>) : string
14448 Returns a string.
14449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014450table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14451 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14452 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14453
14454table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14455 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14456 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14457 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14458
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014459thread : integer
14460 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14461 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14462 and debugging purposes.
14463
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014464var(<var-name>) : undefined
14465 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014466 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14467 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014468 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014469 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14470 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014471 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014472 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14473 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014474 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014475 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014476
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144777.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014478----------------------------------
14479
14480The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14481closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14482methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14483sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14484TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014485the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14486counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014487"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14488used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14489can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14490Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14491table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14492tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14493currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014494
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014495bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014496 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14497 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14498 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014500be_id : integer
14501 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14502 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14503
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014504be_name : string
14505 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14506 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014508dst : ip
14509 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14510 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14511 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14512 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014513 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14514 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14515 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14516 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14517 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14518 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014519
14520dst_conn : integer
14521 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14522 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14523 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14524 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14525 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14526 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14527 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14528 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014529
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014530dst_is_local : boolean
14531 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14532 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14533 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14534 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014535 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014536 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14537 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14538 it only once per connection.
14539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014540dst_port : integer
14541 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14542 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14543 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14544 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14545 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14546 an HTTP header.
14547
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014548fc_http_major : integer
14549 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14550 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14551 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14552
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014553fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14554 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14555 header.
14556
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014557fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14558 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14559 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14560 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14561 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14562 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14563 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14564
14565fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14566 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14567 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14568 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14569 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14570 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14571 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14572
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014573fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14574 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14575 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14576 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14577 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14578
14579fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14580 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14581 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14582 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14583 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14584
14585fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14586 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14587 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14588 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14589 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14590
14591fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14592 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14593 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14594 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14595 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14596
14597fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14598 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14599 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14600 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14601 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14602
14603fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14604 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14605 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14606 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14607 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14608
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014609fe_defbe : string
14610 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14611 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014613fe_id : integer
14614 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014615 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014616 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14617
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014618fe_name : string
14619 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14620 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14621 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14622
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014623sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014624sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14625sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14626sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014627 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14628 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14629 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14630
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014631sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014632sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14633sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14634sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014635 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14636 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14637 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14638
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014639sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014640sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14641sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14642sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014643 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14644 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014645 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14646 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14647 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014648
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014649 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014650 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14651 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014652 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14653 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14654 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014655 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14656 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14657
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014658sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14659sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14660sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14661sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14662 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14663 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14664 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14665 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14666 when a first ACL was verified.
14667
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014668sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014669sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14670sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14671sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014672 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014673 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14674
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014675sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014676sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14677sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14678sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014679 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14680 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14681 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14682
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014683sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014684sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14685sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14686sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014687 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14688 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14689 See also src_conn_rate.
14690
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014691sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014692sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14693sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14694sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014695 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014696 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014697
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014698sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14699sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14700sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14701sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14702 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14703 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14704
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014705sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14706sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14707sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14708sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14709 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14710 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14711
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014712sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014713sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14714sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14715sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014716 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14717 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14718 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014719 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14720 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14721 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014722
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014723sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14724sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14725sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14726sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14727 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14728 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14729 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14730 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14731 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14732 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14733
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014734sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014735sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14736sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14737sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014738 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014739 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14740 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14741
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014742sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014743sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14744sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14745sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014746 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14747 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14748 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14749 src_http_err_rate.
14750
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014751sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014752sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14753sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14754sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014755 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014756 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14757 src_http_req_cnt.
14758
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014759sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014760sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14761sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14762sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014763 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14764 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14765 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14766 src_http_req_rate.
14767
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014768sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014769sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14770sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14771sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014772 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014773 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14774 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14775 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14776 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014777
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014778 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014779 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14780 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014781 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14782
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014783sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14784sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14785sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14786sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14787 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14788 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14789 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14790 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14791 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14792
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014793sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014794sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14795sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14796sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014797 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14798 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14799 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014800
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014801sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014802sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14803sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14804sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014805 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14806 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14807 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014808
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014809sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014810sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14811sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14812sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014813 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014814 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14815 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14816 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014817 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014818 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14819
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014820sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014821sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14822sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14823sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014824 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14825 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14826 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14827 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14828 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014829 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014830
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014831sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014832sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14833sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14834sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014835 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14836 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14837 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14838
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014839sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014840sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14841sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14842sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014843 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14844 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014845 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014846 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14847 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014848 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14849 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14850 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014852so_id : integer
14853 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14854 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14855 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014857src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014858 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014859 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14860 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14861 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014862 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14863 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14864 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014865 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14866 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14867 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14868 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14869 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14870 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14871 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014872
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014873 Example:
14874 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14875 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014877src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14878 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14879 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14880 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014881 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014883src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14884 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14885 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014886 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014887 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014889src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14890 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14891 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14892 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14893 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14894 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14895 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014896
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014897 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014898 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14899 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14900 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14901 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014902 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014903 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14904 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14905
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014906src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14907 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14908 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14909 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14910 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14911 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14912 was verified.
14913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014914src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014915 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014916 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014917 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014918 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014920src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014921 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014922 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14923 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014924 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014926src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14927 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14928 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14929 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014930 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014932src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014933 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014934 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014935 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014936 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014937
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014938src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14939 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14940 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14941 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14942 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14943
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014944src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14945 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14946 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14947 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14948 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014950src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014951 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014952 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014953 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14954 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014955 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14956 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14957 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014958
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014959src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14960 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14961 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14962 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14963 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14964 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14965 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14966 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014968src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014969 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014970 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014971 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014972 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014973 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014975src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14976 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14977 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14978 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14979 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014980 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014982src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014983 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014984 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14985 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014986 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014988src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14989 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14990 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14991 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014992 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014993 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014995src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14996 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14997 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14998 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014999 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015000 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15001 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015002
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015003 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015004 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015005 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015006 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015007
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015008src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15009 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15010 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15011 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15012 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15013 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15014 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15015
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015016src_is_local : boolean
15017 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15018 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15019 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15020 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015021 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015022 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15023 once per connection.
15024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015025src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015026 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15027 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15028 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15029 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15030 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015032src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015033 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15034 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15035 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15036 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15037 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015039src_port : integer
15040 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15041 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15042 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15043 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015045src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015046 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015047 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15048 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15049 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015050 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015052src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15053 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15054 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15055 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15056 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015057 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015059src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15060 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15061 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15062 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15063 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15064 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15065 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15066 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15067 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015068
15069 Example :
15070 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15071 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15072 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15073 listen ssh
15074 bind :22
15075 mode tcp
15076 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015077 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015078 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015079 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015081srv_id : integer
15082 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15083 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15084 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015085
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150867.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015087----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015089The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15090closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15091when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15092usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015093future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015094
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001509551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15096 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15097 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15098 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15099 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15100 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15101
15102 Example :
15103 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15104 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15105 # the request.
15106 frontend http-in
15107 bind *:8081
15108 default_backend servers
15109 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15110 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15111
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015112ssl_bc : boolean
15113 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15114 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15115 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15116
15117ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15118 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15119 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15120
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015121ssl_bc_alpn : string
15122 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15123 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
15124 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
15125 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15126 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15127 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15128 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15129 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15130 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15131
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015132ssl_bc_cipher : string
15133 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15134 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15135
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015136ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15137 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15138 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15139 session or a TLS ticket.
15140
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015141ssl_bc_npn : string
15142 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15143 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
15144 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
15145 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15146 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15147 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15148 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15149 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15150
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015151ssl_bc_protocol : string
15152 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15153 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15154
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015155ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015156 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015157 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15158 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015159
15160ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15161 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15162 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15163 if session was reused or not.
15164
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015165ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15166 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15167 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15168 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15169 BoringSSL.
15170
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015171ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15172 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15173 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015175ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15176 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15177 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15178 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15179 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15180 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015182ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15183 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15184 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15185 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15186 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015187
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015188ssl_c_der : binary
15189 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15190 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15191 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015193ssl_c_err : integer
15194 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15195 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15196 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15197 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15198 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015200ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15201 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15202 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15203 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15204 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15205 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15206 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15207 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15208 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015210ssl_c_key_alg : string
15211 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15212 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15213 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015215ssl_c_notafter : string
15216 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15217 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15218 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015220ssl_c_notbefore : string
15221 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15222 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15223 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015225ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15226 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15227 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15228 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15229 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15230 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15231 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15232 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15233 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015235ssl_c_serial : binary
15236 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15237 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15238 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015240ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15241 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15242 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15243 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015244 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15245 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15246
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015247 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015248 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015250ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15251 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15252 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15253 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015255ssl_c_used : boolean
15256 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15257 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015259ssl_c_verify : integer
15260 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15261 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15262 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15263 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015265ssl_c_version : integer
15266 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15267 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015268
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015269ssl_f_der : binary
15270 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15271 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15272 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015274ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15275 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15276 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15277 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15278 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015279 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015280 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15281 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15282 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015284ssl_f_key_alg : string
15285 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15286 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15287 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015289ssl_f_notafter : string
15290 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15291 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15292 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015294ssl_f_notbefore : string
15295 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15296 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15297 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015299ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15300 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15301 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15302 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15303 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15304 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15305 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15306 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15307 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015309ssl_f_serial : binary
15310 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15311 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15312 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015313
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015314ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15315 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15316 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15317 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015319ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15320 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15321 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15322 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015324ssl_f_version : integer
15325 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15326 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15327
15328ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015329 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15330 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15331 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015333 Example :
15334 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15335 listen http-https
15336 bind :80
15337 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15338 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15339
15340ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15341 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15342 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15343
15344ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015345 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015346 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15347 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15348 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15349 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15350 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15351 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15352 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15353 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015355ssl_fc_cipher : string
15356 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15357 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015358
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015359ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15360 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15361 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015362 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015363
15364ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15365 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15366 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015367 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015368
15369ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15370 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15371 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15372 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015373 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015374 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015375
15376ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15377 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15378 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015379 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015381ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015382 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15383 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015384 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15385 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15386 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15387 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015388
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015389ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15390 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15391 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15392 wait until the handshake happened.
15393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015394ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15395 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015396 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15397 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15398 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15399 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015400
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015401ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015402 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015403 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15404 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015406ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015407 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015408 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15409 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15410 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15411 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15412 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15413 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15414 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015416ssl_fc_protocol : string
15417 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15418 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015419
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015420ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015421 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015422 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15423 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015425ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15426 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15427 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15428 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15429 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015430
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015431ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15432 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15433 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15434 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15435 BoringSSL.
15436
15437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015438ssl_fc_sni : string
15439 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15440 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15441 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15442 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15443 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15444
15445 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15446 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15447 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015448 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15449 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015451 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015452 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15453 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015455ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15456 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15457 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015458
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015459
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154607.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015461------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015463Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15464sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15465only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15466For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15467be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15468can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15469sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15470for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15471content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015473payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015474 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015475 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15476 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015478payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15479 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015480 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015481 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015482
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015483req.hdrs : string
15484 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15485 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15486 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15487 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15488
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015489req.hdrs_bin : binary
15490 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15491 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15492 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15493 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15494 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15495 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15496
15497 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15498
15499 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15500 str: <int:length><bytes>
15501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015502req.len : integer
15503req_len : integer (deprecated)
15504 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15505 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15506 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15507 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15508 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15509 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15510 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15511 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015513req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15514 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015515 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15516 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15517 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15518 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015520 ACL alternatives :
15521 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015523req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15524 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15525 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15526 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15527 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015529 ACL alternatives :
15530 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015532 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015534req.proto_http : boolean
15535req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15536 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15537 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15538 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15539 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15540 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15541 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15542 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015544 Example:
15545 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15546 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15547 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015548 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015550req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15551rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15552 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15553 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15554 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15555 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15556 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15557 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15558 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015560 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15561 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15562 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15563 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15564 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15565 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015567 ACL derivatives :
15568 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015570 Example :
15571 listen tse-farm
15572 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15573 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15574 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15575 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15576 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15577 persist rdp-cookie
15578 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15579 # This is only useful makes sense if
15580 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15581 stick-table type string size 204800
15582 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15583 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15584 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015586 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15587 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015589req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15590rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15591 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15592 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15593 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15594 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015596 ACL derivatives :
15597 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015598
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015599req.ssl_alpn : string
15600 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15601 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15602 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15603 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15604 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15605 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015606 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015607
15608 Examples :
15609 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15610 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15611 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015612 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015613 default_backend bk_default
15614
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015615req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15616 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15617 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015618 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15619 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15620 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15621 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15622 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015624req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15625req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15626 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15627 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15628 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15629 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15630 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15631 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15632 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015634req.ssl_sni : string
15635req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15636 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15637 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15638 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15639 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15640 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15641 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15642 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15643 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15644 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15645 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15646 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15647 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015649 ACL derivatives :
15650 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015652 Examples :
15653 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15654 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15655 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15656 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15657 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015658
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015659req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15660 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15661 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15662 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15663 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15664 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15665 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15666 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15667 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15668 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015670req.ssl_ver : integer
15671req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15672 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15673 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15674 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15675 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15676 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15677 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15678 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015679 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015682 ACL derivatives :
15683 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015684
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015685res.len : integer
15686 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15687 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15688 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15689 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15690 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15691 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15692 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15693 content inspection.
15694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015695res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15696 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015697 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15698 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15699 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15700 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015702res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15703 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15704 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15705 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15706 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015708 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015709
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015710res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15711rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15712 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15713 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15714 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15715 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15716 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15717 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15718 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015720wait_end : boolean
15721 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15722 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015723 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015724 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15725 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015726 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015727 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15728 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015730 Examples :
15731 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15732 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15733 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015735 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15736 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15737 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15738 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15739 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15740 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15741 tcp-request content reject
15742
15743
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157447.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015745--------------------------------------
15746
15747It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15748This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15749data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15750its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15751HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15752content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15753to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15754more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15755response are indexed.
15756
15757base : string
15758 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15759 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15760 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15761 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15762 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15763 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15764 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15765 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15766
15767 ACL derivatives :
15768 base : exact string match
15769 base_beg : prefix match
15770 base_dir : subdir match
15771 base_dom : domain match
15772 base_end : suffix match
15773 base_len : length match
15774 base_reg : regex match
15775 base_sub : substring match
15776
15777base32 : integer
15778 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15779 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15780 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015781 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15782 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15783 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015784
15785base32+src : binary
15786 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15787 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15788 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15789 per-URL counters.
15790
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015791capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15792 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15793 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15794 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15795
15796capture.req.method : string
15797 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15798 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15799 because it's allocated.
15800
15801capture.req.uri : string
15802 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15803 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15804 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15805 allocated.
15806
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015807capture.req.ver : string
15808 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15809 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15810 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15811
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015812capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15813 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15814 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15815 The first entry is an index of 0.
15816 See also: "capture response header"
15817
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015818capture.res.ver : string
15819 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15820 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15821 persistent flag.
15822
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015823req.body : binary
15824 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15825 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15826 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15827 the first chunk is analyzed.
15828
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015829req.body_param([<name>) : string
15830 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15831 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15832 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15833 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15834 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15835 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15836 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15837 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15838 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15839 given.
15840
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015841req.body_len : integer
15842 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15843 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15844 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15845 "option http-buffer-request".
15846
15847req.body_size : integer
15848 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15849 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15850 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15851 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15852 "option http-buffer-request".
15853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015854req.cook([<name>]) : string
15855cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15856 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15857 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15858 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15859 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15860 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15861 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15862 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15863 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15864
15865 ACL derivatives :
15866 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15867 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15868 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15869 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15870 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15871 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15872 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15873 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015875req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15876cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15877 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15878 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015880req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15881cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15882 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15883 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15884 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15885 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015887cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15888 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15889 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15890 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15891 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015892 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015893 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15894 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15895 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15896 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015898hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15899 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15900 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15901 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15902 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015903 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015905req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15906 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15907 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15908 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15909 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15910 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15911 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15912 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15913 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015915req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15916 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15917 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15918 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15919 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015921req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15922 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15923 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15924 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15925 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15926 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15927 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15928 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15929 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015930 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015931 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015932 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015934 ACL derivatives :
15935 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15936 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15937 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15938 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15939 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15940 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15941 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15942 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15943
15944req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15945hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15946 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15947 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15948 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15949 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15950 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15951 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15952 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15953 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15954 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15955
15956req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15957hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15958 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15959 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15960 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15961 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15962 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015963 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015964 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15965 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15966
15967req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15968hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15969 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15970 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15971 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15972 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15973 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15974 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15975 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15976
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010015977req.ungrpc(<field_number>) : binary
15978 This extracts the protocol buffers message in raw mode of a gRPC request body
15979 with <field_number> as terminal field number (dotted notation).
15980
15981 Example:
15982 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15983 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15984
15985 message Point {
15986 int32 latitude = 1;
15987 int32 longitude = 2;
15988 }
15989
15990 message PPoint {
15991 Point point = 59;
15992 }
15993
15994 message Rectangle {
15995 // One corner of the rectangle.
15996 PPoint lo = 48;
15997 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15998 PPoint hi = 49;
15999 }
16000
16001 Let's say a body requests is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16002 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers messages could be fetched
16003 with this "req.ungrpc" sample fetch directives:
16004
16005 req.ungrpc(48.59.1) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16006 req.ungrpc(48.59.2) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16007 req.ungrpc(49.59.1) # "latidude" of "hi" second PPoint
16008 req.ungrpc(49.59.2) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16009
16010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016011http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16012 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16013 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16014 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16015 basic auth is supported.
16016
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016017http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16018 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16019 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16020 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16021 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016022 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16023 basic auth is supported.
16024
16025 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016026 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16027 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16028 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16029 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016030
16031http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016032 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16033 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016034 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16035 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016037method : integer + string
16038 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16039 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16040 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16041 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16042 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16043 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16044 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016046 ACL derivatives :
16047 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016049 Example :
16050 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16051 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16052 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016054path : string
16055 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16056 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16057 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16058 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16059 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016060 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016061 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016063 ACL derivatives :
16064 path : exact string match
16065 path_beg : prefix match
16066 path_dir : subdir match
16067 path_dom : domain match
16068 path_end : suffix match
16069 path_len : length match
16070 path_reg : regex match
16071 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016072
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016073query : string
16074 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16075 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16076 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16077 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016078 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016079 which stops before the question mark.
16080
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016081req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16082 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16083 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16084 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16085 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016087req.ver : string
16088req_ver : string (deprecated)
16089 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16090 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16091 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016093 ACL derivatives :
16094 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016096res.comp : boolean
16097 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16098 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16099 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016101res.comp_algo : string
16102 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16103 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16104 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016106res.cook([<name>]) : string
16107scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16108 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16109 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16110 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016112 ACL derivatives :
16113 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016115res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16116scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16117 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16118 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16119 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016121res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16122scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16123 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16124 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16125 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016127res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16128 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16129 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16130 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16131 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16132 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16133 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16134 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16135 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16136 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016138res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16139 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16140 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16141 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16142 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16143 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016145res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16146shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16147 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16148 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16149 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16150 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16151 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16152 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16153 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16154 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016156 ACL derivatives :
16157 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16158 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16159 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16160 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16161 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16162 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16163 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16164 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16165
16166res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16167shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16168 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16169 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16170 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16171 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16172 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016174res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16175shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16176 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16177 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16178 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16179 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16180 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16181 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016182
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016183res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16184 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16185 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16186 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16187 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016189res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16190shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16191 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16192 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16193 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16194 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16195 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16196 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016198res.ver : string
16199resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16200 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16201 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016203 ACL derivatives :
16204 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016206set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16207 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16208 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016209 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016210 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016212 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16213 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016215status : integer
16216 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16217 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16218 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016219
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016220unique-id : string
16221 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16222 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16223 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16224 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16225 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16226 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016228url : string
16229 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16230 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16231 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16232 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16233 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16234 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16235 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016237 ACL derivatives :
16238 url : exact string match
16239 url_beg : prefix match
16240 url_dir : subdir match
16241 url_dom : domain match
16242 url_end : suffix match
16243 url_len : length match
16244 url_reg : regex match
16245 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016247url_ip : ip
16248 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16249 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16250 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16251 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16252 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16253 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16254 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016256url_port : integer
16257 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16258 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16259 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16260 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016261
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016262urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16263url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016264 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16265 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016266 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16267 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16268 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16269 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016270 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16271 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016272 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16273 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016275 ACL derivatives :
16276 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16277 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16278 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16279 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16280 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16281 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16282 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16283 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016284
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016286 Example :
16287 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16288 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16289 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16290 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016291
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016292urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016293 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16294 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16295 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016296
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016297url32 : integer
16298 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16299 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16300 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16301 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16302 is an unsigned integer.
16303
16304url32+src : binary
16305 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16306 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16307 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16308
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200163107.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016311---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016312
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016313Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16314every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016315order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016317ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16318---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016319FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016320HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016321HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16322HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016323HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16324HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16325HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16326HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16327LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016328METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016329METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016330METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16331METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16332METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16333METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016334METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016335METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016336RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016337REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016338TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016339WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16340---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016341
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163438. Logging
16344----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016345
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016346One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16347provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16348very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16349provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16350state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016351to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016352headers.
16353
16354In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16355about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16356send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16357
16358 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16359 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16360 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16361 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16362 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016363 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016364 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016365
16366The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16367allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16368as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16369while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16370real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16371delay.
16372
16373
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163748.1. Log levels
16375---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016376
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016377TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016378source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016379HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16380in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16381track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16382syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16383about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016384
16385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163868.2. Log formats
16387----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016388
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016389HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016390and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16391slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16392options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016393
16394 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16395 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16396 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16397 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16398 extents.
16399
16400 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16401 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16402 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16403 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16404 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16405
16406 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16407 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16408 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16409 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16410 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16411
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016412 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16413 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16414 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16415 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16416
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016417 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16418
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016419Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16420specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16421field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16422servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16423always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16424identifier.
16425
16426Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16427 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16428 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16429 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16430 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16431
16432
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164338.2.1. Default log format
16434-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016435
16436This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16437as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16438format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16439
16440 Example :
16441 listen www
16442 mode http
16443 log global
16444 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16445
16446 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16447 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16448 (www/HTTP)
16449
16450 Field Format Extract from the example above
16451 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16452 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16453 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16454 4 'to' to
16455 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16456 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16457
16458Detailed fields description :
16459 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16460 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16461 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16462 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16463 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16464 and processed the connection.
16465 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16466
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016467In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16468"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16469connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16470
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016471It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16472will eventually disappear.
16473
16474
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164758.2.2. TCP log format
16476---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016477
16478The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16479is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16480information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16481counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16482emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16483environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16484the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16485sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016486specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16487not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16488fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16489marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016490
16491 Example :
16492 frontend fnt
16493 mode tcp
16494 option tcplog
16495 log global
16496 default_backend bck
16497
16498 backend bck
16499 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16500
16501 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16502 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16503 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16504
16505 Field Format Extract from the example above
16506 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16507 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16508 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16509 4 frontend_name fnt
16510 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16511 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16512 7 bytes_read* 212
16513 8 termination_state --
16514 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16515 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16516
16517Detailed fields description :
16518 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016519 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16520 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16521 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016522 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016523 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016524 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016525
16526 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016527 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16528 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16529 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016530
16531 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16532 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16533 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016534 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16535 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16536 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16537 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016538
16539 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16540 and processed the connection.
16541
16542 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16543 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16544 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16545 applications.
16546
16547 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16548 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16549 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16550 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16551 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16552
16553 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16554 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16555 See "Timers" below for more details.
16556
16557 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16558 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16559 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16560 "Timers" below for more details.
16561
16562 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016563 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016564 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16565 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16566 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16567 details.
16568
16569 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16570 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16571 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16572 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16573 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16574
16575 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16576 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16577 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16578 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16579 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16580 for more details.
16581
16582 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016583 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016584 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16585 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16586 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016587 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016588
16589 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16590 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16591 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16592 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16593 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16594 caused by a denial of service attack.
16595
16596 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16597 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16598 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16599 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16600 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16601 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16602 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16603 denial of service attack.
16604
16605 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16606 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16607 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16608 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16609 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16610 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16611 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16612 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16613 be processed than on other servers.
16614
16615 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16616 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16617 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16618 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16619 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16620 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16621 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16622 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16623 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16624 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16625 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16626 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16627 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16628
16629 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16630 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16631 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16632 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16633 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16634 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016635 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016636 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16637
16638 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16639 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16640 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16641 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16642 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16643 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016644 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016645 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16646 occurs.
16647
16648
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166498.2.3. HTTP log format
16650----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016651
16652The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16653is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16654the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16655are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16656emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16657generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16658"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16659which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016660frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16661is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016662
16663Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16664slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16665with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16666
16667 Example :
16668 frontend http-in
16669 mode http
16670 option httplog
16671 log global
16672 default_backend bck
16673
16674 backend static
16675 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16676
16677 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16678 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16679 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016680 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016681
16682 Field Format Extract from the example above
16683 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16684 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016685 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016686 4 frontend_name http-in
16687 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016688 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016689 7 status_code 200
16690 8 bytes_read* 2750
16691 9 captured_request_cookie -
16692 10 captured_response_cookie -
16693 11 termination_state ----
16694 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16695 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16696 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16697 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16698 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016699
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016700Detailed fields description :
16701 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016702 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16703 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16704 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016705 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016706 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016707 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016708
16709 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016710 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16711 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16712 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016713
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016714 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16715 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016716
16717 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16718 and processed the connection.
16719
16720 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16721 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16722 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16723
16724 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16725 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16726 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16727 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16728 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16729 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16730
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016731 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16732 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16733 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16734 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16735 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16736 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016737 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16738 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016739
16740 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16741 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016742 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016743
16744 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16745 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016746 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16747 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016748
16749 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16750 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16751 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16752 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16753 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016754 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16755 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016756
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016757 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16758 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16759 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16760 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16761 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16762 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16763 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016764 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016765
16766 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16767 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16768 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16769
16770 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16771 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16772 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16773 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16774 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16775 overflowing.
16776
16777 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16778 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16779 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16780 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16781 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16782 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16783 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16784 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16785
16786 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16787 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16788 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16789 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16790 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16791 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16792 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16793 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16794
16795 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16796 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16797 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16798 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16799 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16800 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16801 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16802
16803 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016804 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016805 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16806 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16807 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016808 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016809 system.
16810
16811 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16812 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16813 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16814 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16815 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16816 caused by a denial of service attack.
16817
16818 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16819 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16820 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16821 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16822 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16823 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16824 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16825 denial of service attack.
16826
16827 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16828 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16829 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16830 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16831 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16832 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16833 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16834 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16835 processed than on other servers.
16836
16837 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16838 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16839 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16840 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16841 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16842 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16843 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16844 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16845 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16846 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16847 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16848 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16849 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16850
16851 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16852 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16853 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16854 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16855 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16856 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016857 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016858 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16859
16860 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16861 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16862 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16863 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16864 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16865 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016866 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016867 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16868 occurs.
16869
16870 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16871 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16872 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16873 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16874 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16875 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16876 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16877 cookies" below for more details.
16878
16879 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16880 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16881 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16882 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16883 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16884 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16885 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16886 and cookies" below for more details.
16887
16888 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16889 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16890 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16891 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16892 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16893 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16894 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16895 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16896
16897
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200168988.2.4. Custom log format
16899------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016900
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016901The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016902mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016903
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016904HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016905Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16906separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16907prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16908
16909Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16910variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016911("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016912
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016913If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016914as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016915less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16916the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16917
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016918Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016919In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016920in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016921
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016922Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16923'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16924https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16925such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16926
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016927Flags are :
16928 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016929 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016930 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16931 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016932
16933 Example:
16934
16935 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16936 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16937
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016938 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16939
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016940At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16941
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016942 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16943 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016944
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016945the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016946
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016947 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16948 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16949 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016950
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016951and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16952
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016953 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16954 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016955
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016956Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16957
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016958 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016959 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016960 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16961 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16962 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016963 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16964 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16965 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016966 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016967 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16968 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016969 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016970 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16971 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016972 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016973 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016974 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016975 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016976 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016977 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016978 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016979 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16980 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16981 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16982 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16983 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016984 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016985 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16986 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016987 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016988 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16989 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016990 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16991 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16992 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016993 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016994 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16995 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016996 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016997 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16998 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16999 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017000 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017001 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017002 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17003 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17004 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17005 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017006 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017007 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017008 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017009 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017010 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017011 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017012 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17013 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17014 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017015 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017016 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17017 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017018 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017019 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17020 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017021 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017022 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017023 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017024 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017025
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017026 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017027
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017028
170298.2.5. Error log format
17030-----------------------
17031
17032When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17033protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17034By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17035"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017036will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017037logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17038
17039The format looks like this :
17040
17041 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17042 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17043 Connection error during SSL handshake
17044
17045 Field Format Extract from the example above
17046 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17047 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17048 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17049 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17050 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17051
17052These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17053failures.
17054
17055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170568.3. Advanced logging options
17057-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017058
17059Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17060just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17061options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17062for more information about their usage.
17063
17064
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170658.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17066------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017067
17068It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17069haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17070commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17071monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17072ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17073
17074 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17075 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17076 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17077 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17078
17079 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17080 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17081 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017082 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017083 such as other load-balancers.
17084
17085 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17086 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17087 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17088
17089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17091----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017092
17093The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17094what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17095or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017096"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017097just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17098log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17099after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17100is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17101with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17102with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17103
17104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17106------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017107
17108Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17109for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17110"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17111retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17112raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17113a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17114file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17115you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17116"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17117
17118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171198.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17120--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017121
17122Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17123multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17124them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17125"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17126logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17127error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17128and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17129too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17130useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17131alternative.
17132
17133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171348.4. Timing events
17135------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017136
17137Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17138reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17139the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17140frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017141mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17142addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17143
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017144Timings events in HTTP mode:
17145
17146 first request 2nd request
17147 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17148 t tr t tr ...
17149 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17150 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17151 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17152 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17153 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17154
17155Timings events in TCP mode:
17156
17157 TCP session
17158 |<----------------->|
17159 t t
17160 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17161 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17162 |<------ Tt ------->|
17163
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017164 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017165 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017166 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17167 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17168 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017169 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017170 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17171 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17172 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17173 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017174
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017175 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17176 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17177 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017178 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17179 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17180 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17181 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17182 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17183 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017184
17185 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17186 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17187 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17188 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17189 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17190 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17191 request typed by hand during a test.
17192
17193 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17194 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017195 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017196 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17197 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17198 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17199 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017200
17201 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17202 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17203 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17204 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17205 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17206
17207 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17208 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17209 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17210 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17211 connection never established.
17212
17213 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17214 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17215 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17216 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17217 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17218 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17219 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17220 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17221 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17222 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17223 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17224
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017225 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17226 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17227 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17228 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17229 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17230 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17231
17232 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17233
17234 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17235 "Ta" can never be negative.
17236
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017237 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17238 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017239 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17240 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017241 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017242
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017243 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017244
17245 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017246 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17247 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017248
17249These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17250protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17251that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017252due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17253"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17254that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017255
17256Most common cases :
17257
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017258 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17259 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17260 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17261 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17262 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17263 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17264 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17265 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17266 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17267 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17268 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017269 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017270
17271 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17272 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17273 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17274 of ms on remote networks.
17275
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017276 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17277 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17278 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017279
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017280 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17281 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17282 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17283 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17284 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17285 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17286 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17287 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17288 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017289
17290Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17291
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017292 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017293 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017294 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017295
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017296 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017297 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17298 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17299
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017300 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017301 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17302 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17303 flags.
17304
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017305 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17306 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017307 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17308 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17309 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17310 the client connection was maintained open.
17311
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017312 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017313 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017314 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017315 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17316
17317
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173188.5. Session state at disconnection
17319-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017320
17321TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17322"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
173232-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17324each of which has a special meaning :
17325
17326 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17327 session to terminate :
17328
17329 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17330
17331 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17332 server explicitly refused it.
17333
17334 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17335 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17336 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17337 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017338 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017339
17340 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17341 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017342
17343 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17344 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17345 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17346 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17347 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17348
17349 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17350 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17351 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17352 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17353 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17354
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017355 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17356 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17357
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017358 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17359 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17360 backup connections when going up.
17361
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017362 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17363
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017364 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17365 send or receive data.
17366
17367 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17368 send or receive data.
17369
17370 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17371 with nothing left in the buffers.
17372
17373 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17374
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017375 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017376 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17377
17378 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17379 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17380 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17381 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17382 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17383
17384 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17385 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17386
17387 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17388 server (HTTP only).
17389
17390 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17391
17392 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17393 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17394 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17395
17396 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17397 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17398 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17399
17400 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17401
17402 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17403 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17404
17405 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17406 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17407 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17408
17409 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17410 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017411 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17412 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017413
17414 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17415 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17416 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17417 another server.
17418
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017419 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017420 server.
17421
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017422 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17423 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17424 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17425 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17426
17427 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17428 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17429 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17430 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17431
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017432 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17433 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17434 "use-server" rule).
17435
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017436 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17437
17438 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17439 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17440
17441 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17442
17443 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17444 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17445 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17446
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017447 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17448 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017449 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017450 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17451 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17452
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017453 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17454
17455 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17456 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17457
17458 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17459
17460 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17461
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017462The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17463was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017464helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17465starvation, attacks, etc...
17466
17467The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17468alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17469easier finding and understanding.
17470
17471 Flags Reason
17472
17473 -- Normal termination.
17474
17475 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17476 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17477 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17478 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17479
17480 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17481 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17482 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17483 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17484 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17485 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017486
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017487 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17488 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017489 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017490
17491 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17492 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17493 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17494
17495 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17496 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17497 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17498 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17499 the server takes too long to respond.
17500
17501 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17502 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17503 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17504 long a time to respond.
17505
17506 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17507 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17508 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17509 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017510 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17511 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017512
17513 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17514 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17515 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17516 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17517 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017518 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017519 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17520 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17521 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17522 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17523 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17524 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17525 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17526 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017527 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017528 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17529 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17530 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017531
17532 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17533 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017534 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17535 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17536 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17537 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017538
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017539 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17540 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17541
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017542 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017543 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17544 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017545 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017546 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17547 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17548
17549 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17550 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17551 503 or 504 here.
17552
17553 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17554 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17555 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17556 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17557 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17558
17559 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17560 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017561 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017562 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17563 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17564
17565 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17566 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17567 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17568 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17569 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17570 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17571 between haproxy and the server.
17572
17573 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17574 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17575 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17576 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17577 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17578 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17579 solution is to fix the application.
17580
17581 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17582 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17583 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17584 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17585 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17586 external attacks.
17587
17588 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17589 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017590 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017591 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17592 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17593
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017594 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17595 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17596 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017597 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017598 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017599
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017600 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17601 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17602 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17603 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017604 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17605 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17606 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17607 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17608 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017609
17610 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17611 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17612 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17613 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17614
17615 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17616 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17617 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17618 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17619
17620 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17621 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17622 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17623 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17624
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017625The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17626persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17627important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17628re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17629
17630 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17631
17632 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17633 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17634 set on a GET request.
17635
17636 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17637 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017638 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017639 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17640
17641 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17642 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17643 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17644
17645 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17646 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17647 already got a cookie.
17648
17649 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17650 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17651 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17652 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17653 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17654
17655 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17656 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17657 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17658
17659 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17660 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17661 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17662
17663 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17664 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17665
17666 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17667 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17668 then advertised in the response.
17669
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176718.6. Non-printable characters
17672-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017673
17674In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17675consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17676converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17677prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17678being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17679escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17680is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17681'}' when logging headers.
17682
17683Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17684issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17685containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17686
17687Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17688the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17689performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17690
17691
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176928.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17693---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017694
17695Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17696achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017697section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017698cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17699the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17700the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017701locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017702not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17703user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17704a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17705wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17706
17707 Examples :
17708 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17709 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17710
17711 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17712 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17713
17714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177158.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17716---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017717
17718Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17719proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17720the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17721server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17722
17723Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17724response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017725section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017726
17727It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017728time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17729appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017730are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17731and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17732follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17733request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17734in the logs.
17735
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017736As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17737frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17738an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17739
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017740 Example :
17741 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17742 listen proxy-out
17743 mode http
17744 option httplog
17745 option logasap
17746 log global
17747 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17748
17749 # log the name of the virtual server
17750 capture request header Host len 20
17751
17752 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17753 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17754
17755 # log the beginning of the referrer
17756 capture request header Referer len 20
17757
17758 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17759 capture response header Server len 20
17760
17761 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17762 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17763
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017764 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017765 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17766
17767 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17768 capture response header Via len 20
17769
17770 # log the URL location during a redirection
17771 capture response header Location len 20
17772
17773 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17774 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17775 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17776 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17777 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17778
17779 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17780 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17781 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17782 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017783 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017784
17785 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17786 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17787 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17788 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17789 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017790 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017791
17792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177938.9. Examples of logs
17794---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017795
17796These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17797them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17798reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17799
17800 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17801 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17802 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17803
17804 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17805 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17806
17807 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17808 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17809 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17810
17811 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17812 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17813
17814 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17815 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17816 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17817
17818 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017819 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017820 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17821 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17822
17823 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17824 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17825 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17826
17827 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17828 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017829 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017830 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17831 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17832 to return the 502 and not the server.
17833
17834 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017835 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017836
17837 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17838 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17839 Nothing was sent to any server.
17840
17841 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17842 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17843
17844 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17845 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017846 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017847 send a 408 return code to the client.
17848
17849 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17850 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17851
17852 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17853 5 seconds ("c----").
17854
17855 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17856 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017857 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017858
17859 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017860 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017861 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17862 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17863 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17864 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17865 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017866
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017867
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200178689. Supported filters
17869--------------------
17870
17871Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17872accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17873unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17874
17875See also : "filter"
17876
178779.1. Trace
17878----------
17879
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017880filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017881
17882 Arguments:
17883 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17884 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17885
17886 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17887 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17888 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17889 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17890
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017891 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017892 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17893 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17894 amount of the parsed data.
17895
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017896 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017897
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017898This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17899callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17900information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17901filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17902
17903Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17904tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17905a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17906
17907
179089.2. HTTP compression
17909---------------------
17910
17911filter compression
17912
17913The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17914keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017915when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
17916it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
17917response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
17918line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
17919cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
17920the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017921
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017922See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017923
17924
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200179259.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17926--------------------------------------------
17927
17928filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17929
17930 Arguments :
17931
17932 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17933 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17934 parsed.
17935
17936 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17937 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17938 part must be placed in its own scope.
17939
17940The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17941external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017942streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017943exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17944also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17945
17946SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17947the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17948
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017949For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017950"doc/SPOE.txt".
17951
17952Important note:
17953 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17954 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17955
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100179569.4. Cache
17957----------
17958
17959filter cache <name>
17960
17961 Arguments :
17962
17963 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17964
17965The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17966"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
17967cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017968other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
17969the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
17970mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17971filter other than the compression is used for the same
17972listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17973order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017974
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017975See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017976
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001797710. Cache
17978---------
17979
17980HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17981(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17982RAM.
17983
17984The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017985this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017986
17987If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17988independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17989when we try to allocate a new one.
17990
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017991The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017992
17993It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17994"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17995for more details.
17996
17997When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17998replaced by "<CACHE>".
17999
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001800010.1. Limitation
18001----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018002
18003The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18004
18005- If the response is not a 200
18006- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018007- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018008- If the response is not cacheable
18009
18010- If the request is not a GET
18011- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018012- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018013
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018014Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18015filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18016can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18017example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18018"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018019
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001802010.2. Setup
18021-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018022
18023To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18024the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18025
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001802610.2.1. Cache section
18027---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018028
18029cache <name>
18030 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18031 size of cache is mandatory.
18032
18033total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018034 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018035 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018036
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018037max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018038 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18039 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18040 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018041
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018042max-age <seconds>
18043 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18044 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18045 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18046 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18047 default.
18048
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001804910.2.2. Proxy section
18050---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018051
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018052http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018053 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18054 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18055 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18056 after this one.
18057
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018058http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018059 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18060 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18061 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18062 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18063
18064
18065Example:
18066
18067 backend bck1
18068 mode http
18069
18070 http-request cache-use foobar
18071 http-response cache-store foobar
18072 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18073
18074 cache foobar
18075 total-max-size 4
18076 max-age 240
18077
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018078/*
18079 * Local variables:
18080 * fill-column: 79
18081 * End:
18082 */